]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - ld/ld.texi
24e9debfb5f9817987fe10a25b7d79f917bf8493
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-linker-version
465 @item --enable-linker-version
466 Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467 in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468 script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469 linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471 Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472 significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473 the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475 @kindex --disable-linker-version
476 @item --disable-linker-version
477 Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478 does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
480 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490 @smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509 @end smallexample
510
511 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516 This option enables warnings when
517 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520 output region.
521
522 @cindex entry point, from command line
523 @kindex -e @var{entry}
524 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
525 @item -e @var{entry}
526 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
535 @kindex --exclude-libs
536 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
538 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
539 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544 be treated as hidden.
545
546 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557 regardless of this option.
558
559 @cindex dynamic symbol table
560 @kindex -E
561 @kindex --export-dynamic
562 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
563 @item -E
564 @itemx --export-dynamic
565 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
566 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
575
576 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579 linking the program itself.
580
581 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
582 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
583 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
584
585 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
589 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590 @cindex export dynamic symbol
591 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
602 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
607 @ifclear SingleFormat
608 @cindex big-endian objects
609 @cindex endianness
610 @kindex -EB
611 @item -EB
612 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614 @cindex little-endian objects
615 @kindex -EL
616 @item -EL
617 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
618 @end ifclear
619
620 @kindex -f @var{name}
621 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622 @item -f @var{name}
623 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
624 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
637 machine-specific performance.
638
639 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
642 @kindex -F @var{name}
643 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
644 @item -F @var{name}
645 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
646 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657 @var{name}.
658
659 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
660 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
661 object files.
662 @ifclear SingleFormat
663 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
664 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
665 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
666 environment variable.
667 @end ifclear
668 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669 creating an ELF shared object.
670
671 @cindex finalization function
672 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
673 @item -fini=@var{name}
674 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677 the function to call.
678
679 @kindex -g
680 @item -g
681 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
683 @kindex -G @var{value}
684 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
685 @cindex object size
686 @item -G @var{value}
687 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
690 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
691 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693 @cindex runtime library name
694 @kindex -h @var{name}
695 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
696 @item -h @var{name}
697 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
698 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
702 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
703
704 @kindex -i
705 @cindex incremental link
706 @item -i
707 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
709 @cindex initialization function
710 @kindex -init=@var{name}
711 @item -init=@var{name}
712 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715 function to call.
716
717 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
718 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
719 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
720 @item -l @var{namespec}
721 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
725 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
726 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
727
728 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
729 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735 @var{filename}.
736
737 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
744 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
745 archives multiple times.
746
747 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749 @ifset GENERIC
750 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
751 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
752 behaviour of the AIX linker.
753 @end ifset
754
755 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
756 @kindex -L @var{dir}
757 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
758 @item -L @var{searchdir}
759 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
760 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
762 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
765 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
766 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768 option is specified.
769
770 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
773
774 @ifset UsesEnvVars
775 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
776 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
777 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778 @end ifset
779
780 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784 @cindex emulation
785 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
786 @item -m @var{emulation}
787 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794 configured.
795
796 @cindex remapping inputs
797 @kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798 @kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799 @item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800 @itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801 These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802 linker attempts to open them. The option
803 @option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804 file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805 @file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806 so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807 matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809 An alternative form of the option
810 @option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811 from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812 Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813 the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814 The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815 or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817 The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818 accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819 they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820 order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821 checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823 If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824 then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825 This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826 from a complicated build environment.
827
828 Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829 that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831 @smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833 @end smallexample
834
835 Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837 @smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839 @end smallexample
840
841 Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843 Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844 statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845 after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846 options on the command line is not significant.
847
848 If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849 will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850 be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851 appear.
852
853 If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854 the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
856 @cindex link map
857 @kindex -M
858 @kindex --print-map
859 @item -M
860 @itemx --print-map
861 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862 information about the link, including the following:
863
864 @itemize @bullet
865 @item
866 Where object files are mapped into memory.
867 @item
868 How common symbols are allocated.
869 @item
870 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
872 @item
873 The values assigned to symbols.
874
875 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881 linker script containing:
882
883 @smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887 @end smallexample
888
889 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890 option is used:
891
892 @smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896 @end smallexample
897
898 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899 scripts.
900
901 @item
902 How GNU properties are merged.
903
904 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
907
908 @smallexample
909 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910 @end smallexample
911
912 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
913 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916 @smallexample
917 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
918 @end smallexample
919
920 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
921 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
923 @end itemize
924
925 @cindex link map discarded
926 @kindex --print-map-discarded
927 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928 @item --print-map-discarded
929 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931 in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
933 @kindex --print-map-locals
934 @kindex --no-print-map-locals
935 @item --print-map-locals
936 @itemx --no-print-map-locals
937 Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938 will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939 be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940 Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941 will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
943 @kindex -n
944 @cindex read-only text
945 @cindex NMAGIC
946 @kindex --nmagic
947 @item -n
948 @itemx --nmagic
949 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
952
953 @kindex -N
954 @kindex --omagic
955 @cindex read/write from cmd line
956 @cindex OMAGIC
957 @item -N
958 @itemx --omagic
959 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
960 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
962 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964 specification published by Microsoft.
965
966 @kindex --no-omagic
967 @cindex OMAGIC
968 @item --no-omagic
969 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
973
974 @kindex -o @var{output}
975 @kindex --output=@var{output}
976 @cindex naming the output file
977 @item -o @var{output}
978 @itemx --output=@var{output}
979 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
980 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
983 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984 @cindex dependency file
985 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
998 @kindex -O @var{level}
999 @cindex generating optimized output
1000 @item -O @var{level}
1001 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
1002 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
1003 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
1008
1009 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010 @item -plugin @var{name}
1011 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015 wish.
1016
1017 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
1021 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
1022 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
1023 just copy in the newest one.
1024
1025 @kindex --push-state
1026 @cindex push state governing input file handling
1027 @item --push-state
1028 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
1029 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042 something as follows:
1043
1044 @smallexample
1045 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046 @end smallexample
1047
1048 @kindex --pop-state
1049 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
1050 @item --pop-state
1051 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052 flags governing input file handling.
1053
1054 @kindex -q
1055 @kindex --emit-relocs
1056 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057 @item -q
1058 @itemx --emit-relocs
1059 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
1060 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062 in larger executables.
1063
1064 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
1066 @kindex --force-dynamic
1067 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068 @item --force-dynamic
1069 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070 to VxWorks targets.
1071
1072 @cindex partial link
1073 @cindex relocatable output
1074 @kindex -r
1075 @kindex --relocatable
1076 @item -r
1077 @itemx --relocatable
1078 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
1079 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
1080 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082 @code{OMAGIC}.
1083 @c ; see @option{-N}.
1084 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
1088 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092 with input files in other formats at all.
1093
1094 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096 @kindex -R @var{file}
1097 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098 @cindex symbol-only input
1099 @item -R @var{filename}
1100 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
1106 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1107 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1108 the @option{-rpath} option.
1109
1110 @kindex -s
1111 @kindex --strip-all
1112 @cindex strip all symbols
1113 @item -s
1114 @itemx --strip-all
1115 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117 @kindex -S
1118 @kindex --strip-debug
1119 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1120 @item -S
1121 @itemx --strip-debug
1122 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
1124 @kindex --strip-discarded
1125 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126 @item --strip-discarded
1127 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129 Enabled by default.
1130
1131 @kindex -t
1132 @kindex --trace
1133 @cindex input files, displaying
1134 @item -t
1135 @itemx --trace
1136 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140 a linker bug report.
1141
1142 @kindex -T @var{script}
1143 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1144 @cindex script files
1145 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1148 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149 unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
1150 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1151 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154 options accumulate.
1155
1156 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1157 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158 @cindex script files
1159 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170 @samp{gcc}).
1171
1172 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174 @cindex undefined symbol
1175 @item -u @var{symbol}
1176 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
1183 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186 instead.
1187
1188 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189 @cindex symbols, require defined
1190 @cindex defined symbol
1191 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
1199 @kindex -Ur
1200 @cindex constructors
1201 @item -Ur
1202
1203 For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204 based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205 relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206 input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207 option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208 constructors and destructors.
1209
1210 For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211 differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212 themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213 been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214 partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
1215
1216 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217 @cindex orphan sections
1218 @cindex sections, orphan
1219 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225 @table @code
1226 @item place
1227 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1229 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1230
1231 @item discard
1232 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235 @item warn
1236 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237 issue a warning.
1238
1239 @item error
1240 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241 @end table
1242
1243 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
1245 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253 in a linker script.
1254
1255 @kindex -v
1256 @kindex -V
1257 @kindex --version
1258 @cindex version
1259 @item -v
1260 @itemx --version
1261 @itemx -V
1262 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1263 lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264 @option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265 which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
1266
1267 @kindex -x
1268 @kindex --discard-all
1269 @cindex deleting local symbols
1270 @item -x
1271 @itemx --discard-all
1272 Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274 @kindex -X
1275 @kindex --discard-locals
1276 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1277 @item -X
1278 @itemx --discard-locals
1279 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1282
1283 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285 @cindex symbol tracing
1286 @item -y @var{symbol}
1287 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290 to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1296 @item -Y @var{path}
1297 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298 for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301 @item -z @var{keyword}
1302 The recognized keywords are:
1303 @table @samp
1304
1305 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
1317 @item cet-report=none
1318 @itemx cet-report=warning
1319 @itemx cet-report=error
1320 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
1332 @item combreloc
1333 @itemx nocombreloc
1334 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1336
1337 @item common
1338 @itemx nocommon
1339 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345 using pages of this size.
1346
1347 @item defs
1348 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1351
1352 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360 these options.
1361
1362 @item execstack
1363 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
1365 @item global
1366 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
1370 @item globalaudit
1371 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1375 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1376 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1377
1378 @item ibtplt
1379 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
1382 @item ibt
1383 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
1387 @item indirect-extern-access
1388 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397 section.
1398
1399 @item initfirst
1400 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405 objects.
1406
1407 @item interpose
1408 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410 libraries not so marked.
1411
1412 @item unique
1413 @itemx nounique
1414 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
1422 @item lam-u48
1423 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426 @item lam-u57
1427 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430 @item lam-u48-report=none
1431 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442 @item lam-u57-report=none
1443 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454 @item lam-report=none
1455 @itemx lam-report=warning
1456 @itemx lam-report=error
1457 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
1466 @item lazy
1467 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470 Lazy binding is the default.
1471
1472 @item loadfltr
1473 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1474
1475 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1477
1478 @item muldefs
1479 Allow multiple definitions.
1480
1481 @item nocopyreloc
1482 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1483 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1484
1485 @item nodefaultlib
1486 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1487 should ignore any default library search paths.
1488
1489 @item nodelete
1490 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1491
1492 @item nodlopen
1493 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1494
1495 @item nodump
1496 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1497
1498 @item noexecstack
1499 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1500
1501 @item noextern-protected-data
1502 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1503 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1504 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1505 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1506 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1507 i386 and x86-64.
1508
1509 @item noreloc-overflow
1510 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1511 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1512 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1513
1514 @item now
1515 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1516 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1517 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1518 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1519 called.
1520
1521 @item origin
1522 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1523
1524 @item pack-relative-relocs
1525 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1526 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1527 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1528 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1529 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1530 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1531 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1532 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1533 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1534
1535 @item relro
1536 @itemx norelro
1537 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1538 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1539 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1540 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1541 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1542
1543 @item report-relative-reloc
1544 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1545 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1546
1547 @item sectionheader
1548 @itemx nosectionheader
1549 Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1550 @samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1551
1552 @item separate-code
1553 @itemx noseparate-code
1554 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1555 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1556 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1557 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1558
1559 @item shstk
1560 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1561 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1562 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1563
1564 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1565 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1566 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1567 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1568
1569 @item start-stop-gc
1570 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1571 @cindex start-stop-gc
1572 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1573 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1574 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1575 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1576 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1577 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1578 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1579 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1580 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1581 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1582 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1583 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1584 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1585
1586 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1587 @cindex visibility
1588 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1589 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1590 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1591 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1592 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1593 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1594 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1595 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1596 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1597 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1598
1599 @item text
1600 @itemx notext
1601 @itemx textoff
1602 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1603 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1604 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1605
1606 @item undefs
1607 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1608 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1609 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1610
1611 @item unique-symbol
1612 @itemx nounique-symbol
1613 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1614 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1615 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1616
1617 @item x86-64-baseline
1618 @item x86-64-v2
1619 @item x86-64-v3
1620 @itemx x86-64-v4
1621 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1622 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1623 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1624 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1625 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1626 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1627
1628 @end table
1629
1630 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1631
1632 @kindex -(
1633 @cindex groups of archives
1634 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1635 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1636 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1637 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1638
1639 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1640 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1641 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1642 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1643 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1644 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1645 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1646 resolved.
1647
1648 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1649 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1650 more archives.
1651
1652 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1653 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1654 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1655 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1656 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1657 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1658 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1659 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1660 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1661 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1662 restore the old behaviour.
1663
1664 @kindex --as-needed
1665 @kindex --no-as-needed
1666 @item --as-needed
1667 @itemx --no-as-needed
1668 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1669 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1670 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1671 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1672 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1673 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1674 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1675 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1676 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1677 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1678 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1679 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1680 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1681
1682 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1683 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1684 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1685 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1686
1687 @kindex --add-needed
1688 @kindex --no-add-needed
1689 @item --add-needed
1690 @itemx --no-add-needed
1691 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1692 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1693 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1694 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1695
1696 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1697 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1698 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1699
1700 @kindex -Bdynamic
1701 @kindex -dy
1702 @kindex -call_shared
1703 @item -Bdynamic
1704 @itemx -dy
1705 @itemx -call_shared
1706 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1707 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1708 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1709 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1710 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1711 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1712
1713 @kindex -Bgroup
1714 @item -Bgroup
1715 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1716 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1717 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1718 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1719 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1720
1721 @kindex -Bstatic
1722 @kindex -dn
1723 @kindex -non_shared
1724 @kindex -static
1725 @item -Bstatic
1726 @itemx -dn
1727 @itemx -non_shared
1728 @itemx -static
1729 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1730 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1731 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1732 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1733 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1734 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1735 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1736 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1737 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1738 libraries.
1739
1740 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1741 @item -Bsymbolic
1742 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1743 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1744 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1745 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1746 platforms which support shared libraries.
1747
1748 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1749 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1750 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1751 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1752 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1753 libraries.
1754
1755 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1756 @item -Bno-symbolic
1757 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1758 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1759
1760 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1761 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1762 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1763 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1764 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1765 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1766 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1767 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1768 which support shared libraries.
1769
1770 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1771 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1772
1773 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1774 @item --dynamic-list-data
1775 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1776
1777 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1778 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1779 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1780 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1781
1782 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1783 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1784 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1785
1786 @kindex --check-sections
1787 @kindex --no-check-sections
1788 @item --check-sections
1789 @itemx --no-check-sections
1790 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1791 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1792 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1793 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1794 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1795 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1796 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1797 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1798 option.
1799
1800 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1801 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1802 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1803 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1804 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1805 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1806 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1807 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1808 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1809 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1810 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1811 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1812
1813 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1814 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1815 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1816 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1817 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1818 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1819 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1820 symbols.
1821
1822 @cindex cross reference table
1823 @kindex --cref
1824 @item --cref
1825 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1826 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1827 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1828
1829 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1830 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1831 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1832 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1833 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1834 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1835 symbol are listed.
1836
1837 @cindex ctf variables
1838 @kindex --ctf-variables
1839 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1840 @item --ctf-variables
1841 @item --no-ctf-variables
1842 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1843 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1844 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1845 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1846 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1847 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1848 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1849
1850 @cindex ctf type sharing
1851 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1852 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1853 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1854
1855 @table @samp
1856 @item share-unconflicted
1857 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1858 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1859 translation unit. This is the default.
1860
1861 @item share-duplicated
1862 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1863 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1864 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1865 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1866 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1867 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1868 consumer at runtime.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 @cindex common allocation
1872 @kindex --no-define-common
1873 @item --no-define-common
1874 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1875 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1876 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1877
1878 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1879 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1880 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1881 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1882 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1883 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1884 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1885 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1886 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1887 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1888
1889 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1890 @cindex section groups
1891 @cindex COMDAT
1892 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1893 @item --force-group-allocation
1894 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1895 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1896 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1897 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1898 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1899 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1900
1901 @cindex symbols, from command line
1902 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1903 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1904 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1905 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1906 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1907 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1908 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1909 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1910 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1911 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1912 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1913 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1914
1915 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1916 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1917 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1918 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1919 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1920 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1921 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1922 you are trying to achieve.
1923
1924 @cindex demangling, from command line
1925 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1926 @kindex --no-demangle
1927 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1928 @itemx --no-demangle
1929 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1930 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1931 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1932 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1933 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1934 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1935 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1936 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1937 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1938
1939 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1940 @kindex -I@var{file}
1941 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1942 @item -I@var{file}
1943 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1944 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1945 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1946 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1947 doing.
1948
1949 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1950 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1951 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1952 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1953 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1954 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1955
1956 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1957 @item --embedded-relocs
1958 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1959 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1960 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1961 targets.
1962
1963 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1964 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1965 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1966 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1967
1968 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1969 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1970 @item --fatal-warnings
1971 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1972 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1973 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1974
1975 @kindex -w
1976 @kindex --no-warnings
1977 @item -w
1978 @itemx --no-warnings
1979 Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1980 @option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1981 used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1982 is still a need to create it.
1983
1984 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1985 @item --force-exe-suffix
1986 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1987
1988 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1989 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1990 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1991 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1992 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1993 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1994
1995 @kindex --gc-sections
1996 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1997 @cindex garbage collection
1998 @item --gc-sections
1999 @itemx --no-gc-sections
2000 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
2001 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
2002 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
2003 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2004 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2005 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
2006
2007 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2008 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2009 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2010 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2011 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2012 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2013 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2014 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
2015 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2016 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
2017
2018 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
2019 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
2020 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2021 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2022 command in the linker script.
2023
2024 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2025 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2026
2027 @kindex --print-gc-sections
2028 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2029 @cindex garbage collection
2030 @item --print-gc-sections
2031 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2032 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2033 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2034 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2035 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2036 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2037 line.
2038
2039 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
2040 @cindex garbage collection
2041 @item --gc-keep-exported
2042 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2043 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2044 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2045 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2046 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2047 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2048 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2049 ELF format targets.
2050
2051 @kindex --print-output-format
2052 @cindex output format
2053 @item --print-output-format
2054 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2055 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2056 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2057
2058 @kindex --print-memory-usage
2059 @cindex memory usage
2060 @item --print-memory-usage
2061 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2062 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2063 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2064 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2065 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2066
2067 @smallexample
2068 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2069 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2070 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2071 @end smallexample
2072
2073 @cindex help
2074 @cindex usage
2075 @kindex --help
2076 @item --help
2077 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2078
2079 @kindex --target-help
2080 @item --target-help
2081 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
2082
2083 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2084 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
2085 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2086 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2087 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2088
2089 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2090 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2091 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2092 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2093 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2094 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2095 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2096
2097 @smallexample
2098 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2099 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2100 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2101 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2102 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2103 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2104 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2105 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2106 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2107 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2111
2112 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2113 operation.
2114
2115 @cindex memory usage
2116 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2117 @item --no-keep-memory
2118 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2119 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2120 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2121 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2122 while linking a large executable.
2123
2124 @kindex --no-undefined
2125 @kindex -z defs
2126 @kindex -z undefs
2127 @item --no-undefined
2128 @itemx -z defs
2129 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2130 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2131 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2132 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2133 libraries being linked in.
2134
2135 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2136
2137 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2138 @kindex -z muldefs
2139 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2140 @itemx -z muldefs
2141 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2142 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2143 first definition will be used.
2144
2145 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2146 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2147 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2148 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2149 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2150 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2151 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2152 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2153 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2154
2155 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2156 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2157 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2158 a shared library.
2159
2160 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2161 libraries specified at link time are that:
2162
2163 @itemize @bullet
2164 @item
2165 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2166 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2167 resolvable at load time.
2168 @item
2169 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2170 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2171
2172 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2173 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2174 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2175 appropriate memset function.
2176 @end itemize
2177
2178 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2179 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2180 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2181 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2182 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2183 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2184 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2185 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2186 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2187 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2188 error message will be displayed.
2189
2190 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2191 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2192
2193 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2194 @item --no-undefined-version
2195 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2196 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2197 will be issued instead.
2198
2199 @kindex --default-symver
2200 @item --default-symver
2201 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2202 exported symbols.
2203
2204 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2205 @item --default-imported-symver
2206 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2207 imported symbols.
2208
2209 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2210 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2211 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2212 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2213 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2214 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2215 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2216 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2217 inappropriate.
2218
2219 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2220 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2221 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2222 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2223
2224 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2225 @item --no-whole-archive
2226 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2227 archive files.
2228
2229 @cindex output file after errors
2230 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2231 @item --noinhibit-exec
2232 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2233 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2234 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2235 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2236
2237 @kindex -nostdlib
2238 @item -nostdlib
2239 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2240 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2241 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2242
2243 @ifclear SingleFormat
2244 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2245 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2246 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2247 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2248 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2249 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2250 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2251 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2252 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2253 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2254 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2255 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2256 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2257 @end ifclear
2258
2259 @kindex --out-implib
2260 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2261 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2262 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2263 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2264 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2265 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2266 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2267 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2268
2269 @kindex -pie
2270 @kindex --pic-executable
2271 @item -pie
2272 @itemx --pic-executable
2273 @cindex position independent executables
2274 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2275 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2276 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2277 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2278 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2279 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2280
2281 @kindex -no-pie
2282 @item -no-pie
2283 @cindex position dependent executables
2284 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2285
2286 @kindex -qmagic
2287 @item -qmagic
2288 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2289
2290 @kindex -Qy
2291 @item -Qy
2292 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2293
2294 @kindex --relax
2295 @cindex synthesizing linker
2296 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2297 @cindex --no-relax
2298 @item --relax
2299 @itemx --no-relax
2300 An option with machine dependent effects.
2301 @ifset GENERIC
2302 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2303 @end ifset
2304 @ifset H8300
2305 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2306 @end ifset
2307 @ifset XTENSA
2308 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2309 @end ifset
2310 @ifset M68HC11
2311 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2312 @end ifset
2313 @ifset NIOSII
2314 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2315 @end ifset
2316 @ifset POWERPC
2317 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2318 @end ifset
2319
2320 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2321 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2322 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2323 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2324 instructions, and combining constant values.
2325
2326 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2327 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2328 @ifset GENERIC
2329 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2330 family of processors.
2331 @end ifset
2332
2333 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2334 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2335
2336 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2337 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2338
2339 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2340 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2341 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2342 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2343 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2344 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2345 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2346 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2347 @ifset GENERIC
2348 (such as VxWorks)
2349 @end ifset
2350 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2351 run-time memory.
2352
2353 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2354 or symbols needed for relocations.
2355
2356 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2357 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2358
2359 @ifset GENERIC
2360 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2361 @cindex runtime library search path
2362 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2363 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2364 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2365 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2366 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2367
2368 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2369 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2370 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2371 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2372 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2373
2374 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2375 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2376 is defined.
2377
2378 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2379 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2380 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2381 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2382 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2383 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2384 file systems.
2385
2386 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2387 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2388 the @option{-rpath} option.
2389 @end ifset
2390
2391 @ifset GENERIC
2392 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2393 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2394 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2395 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2396 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2397 of the input files.
2398
2399 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2400 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2401 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2402 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2403 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2404 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2405 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2406 appearing multiple times.
2407
2408 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2409 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2410 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2411 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2412 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2413
2414 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2415 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2416 supported.
2417
2418 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2419 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2420 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2421 runtime linker would do.
2422
2423 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2424 libraries:
2425
2426 @enumerate
2427 @item
2428 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2429 @item
2430 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2431 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2432 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2433 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2434 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2435 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2436 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2437 @item
2438 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2439 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2440 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2441 @item
2442 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2443 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2444 @item
2445 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2446 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2447 @item
2448 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2449 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2450 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2451 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2452 @item
2453 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2454 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2455 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2456 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2457 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2458 @item
2459 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2460 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2461 header file.
2462 @item
2463 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2464 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2465 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2466 @item
2467 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2468 @item
2469 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2470 @item
2471 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2472 linker script.
2473 @end enumerate
2474
2475 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2476 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2477 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2478 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2479 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2480 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2481 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2482 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2483 of the first.
2484
2485 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2486 warning and continue with the link.
2487
2488 @end ifset
2489
2490 @kindex -shared
2491 @kindex -Bshareable
2492 @item -shared
2493 @itemx -Bshareable
2494 @cindex shared libraries
2495 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2496 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2497 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2498 undefined symbols in the link.
2499
2500 @kindex --sort-common
2501 @item --sort-common
2502 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2503 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2504 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2505 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2506 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2507 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2508 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2509 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2510
2511 @kindex --sort-section=name
2512 @item --sort-section=name
2513 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2514 patterns in the linker script.
2515
2516 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2517 @item --sort-section=alignment
2518 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2519 patterns in the linker script.
2520
2521 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2522 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2523 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2524 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2525 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2526
2527 @kindex --split-by-file
2528 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2529 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2530 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2531 size of 1 if not given.
2532
2533 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2534 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2535 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2536 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2537 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2538 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2539 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2540 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2541 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2542 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2543 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2544 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2545
2546 @kindex --stats
2547 @item --stats
2548 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2549 as execution time and memory usage.
2550
2551 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2552 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2553 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2554 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2555 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2556
2557 @kindex --task-link
2558 @item --task-link
2559 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2560 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2561
2562 @kindex --traditional-format
2563 @cindex traditional format
2564 @item --traditional-format
2565 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2566 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2567 use the traditional format instead.
2568
2569 @cindex dbx
2570 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2571 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2572 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2573 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2574 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2575 combine duplicate entries.
2576
2577 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2578 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2579 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2580 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2581 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2582 line.
2583 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2584 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2585 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2586 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2587 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2588
2589 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2590 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2591 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2592 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2593 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2594 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2595 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2596 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2597 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2598
2599 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2600 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2601 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2602 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2603 byte of the text segment.
2604
2605 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2606 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2607 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2608 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2609 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2610 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2611
2612 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2613 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2614 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2615 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2616 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2617
2618 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2619 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2620 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2621 values for @samp{method}:
2622
2623 @table @samp
2624 @item ignore-all
2625 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2626
2627 @item report-all
2628 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2629
2630 @item ignore-in-object-files
2631 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2632 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2633
2634 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2635 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2636 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2637 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2638 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2639 command line.
2640 @end table
2641
2642 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2643 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2644
2645 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2646 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2647 can change this to a warning.
2648
2649 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2650 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2651 @item --dll-verbose
2652 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2653 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2654 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2655 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2656 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2657
2658 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2659 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2660 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2661 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2662 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2663 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2664 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2665 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2666 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2667 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2668 @xref{WIN32}.
2669
2670 @kindex --warn-common
2671 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2672 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2673 @item --warn-common
2674 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2675 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2676 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2677 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2678 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2679 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2680
2681 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2682
2683 @table @samp
2684 @item int i = 1;
2685 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2686 file.
2687
2688 @item extern int i;
2689 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2690 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2691 variable somewhere.
2692
2693 @item int i;
2694 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2695 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2696 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2697 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2698 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2699 a definition of the same variable.
2700 @end table
2701
2702 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2703 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2704 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2705 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2706 a common symbol.
2707
2708 @enumerate
2709 @item
2710 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2711 definition for the symbol.
2712 @smallexample
2713 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2714 overridden by definition
2715 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2716 @end smallexample
2717
2718 @item
2719 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2720 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2721 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2722 @smallexample
2723 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2724 overriding common
2725 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2726 @end smallexample
2727
2728 @item
2729 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2730 @smallexample
2731 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2732 of `@var{symbol}'
2733 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2734 @end smallexample
2735
2736 @item
2737 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2738 @smallexample
2739 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2740 overridden by larger common
2741 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2742 @end smallexample
2743
2744 @item
2745 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2746 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2747 encountered in a different order.
2748 @smallexample
2749 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2750 overriding smaller common
2751 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2752 @end smallexample
2753 @end enumerate
2754
2755 @kindex --warn-constructors
2756 @item --warn-constructors
2757 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2758 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2759 detect the use of global constructors.
2760
2761 @kindex --warn-execstack
2762 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2763 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2764 @item --warn-execstack
2765 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2766 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2767 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2768 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2769 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2770 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2771
2772 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2773 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2774 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2775 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2776 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2777
2778 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2779 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2780 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2781 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2782 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2783 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2784 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2785 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2786 crafted assembler files.
2787
2788 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2789 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2790 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2791 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2792 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2793 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2794 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2795 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2796 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2797 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2798 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2799 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2800 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2801
2802 @kindex --warn-once
2803 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2804 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2805 @item --warn-once
2806 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2807 which refers to it.
2808
2809 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2810 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2811 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2812 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2813 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2814 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2815 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2816 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2817 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2818 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2819 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2820
2821 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2822 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2823 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2824
2825 @kindex --warn-section-align
2826 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2827 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2828 @item --warn-section-align
2829 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2830 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2831 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2832 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2833 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2834
2835 @kindex --warn-textrel
2836 @item --warn-textrel
2837 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2838 or shared object.
2839
2840 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2841 @item --warn-alternate-em
2842 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2843
2844 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2845 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2846 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2847 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2848 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2849
2850 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2851 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2852 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2853 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2854
2855 @kindex --whole-archive
2856 @cindex including an entire archive
2857 @item --whole-archive
2858 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2859 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2860 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2861 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2862 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2863 library. This option may be used more than once.
2864
2865 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2866 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2867 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2868 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2869 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2870
2871 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2872 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2873 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2874 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2875 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2876 @var{symbol}.
2877
2878 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2879 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2880 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2881 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2882
2883 Here is a trivial example:
2884
2885 @smallexample
2886 void *
2887 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2888 @{
2889 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2890 return __real_malloc (c);
2891 @}
2892 @end smallexample
2893
2894 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2895 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2896 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2897 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2898
2899 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2900 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2901 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2902 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2903 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2904
2905 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2906 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2907 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2908 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2909
2910 @smallexample
2911 int
2912 f (void)
2913 @{
2914 return 123;
2915 @}
2916
2917 int
2918 g (void)
2919 @{
2920 return f();
2921 @}
2922 @end smallexample
2923
2924 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2925 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2926 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2927 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2928 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2929 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2930 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2931
2932 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2933 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2934 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2935 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2936 if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
2937 controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
2938 generated code sections like PLT.
2939
2940 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2941 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2942 @item --enable-new-dtags
2943 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2944 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2945 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2946 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2947 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2948 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2949 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2950 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2951
2952 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2953 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2954 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2955 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2956 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2957 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2958 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2959
2960 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2961 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2962 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2963 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2964 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2965 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2966 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2967 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2968
2969 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2970 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2971 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2972 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2973 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2974 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2975 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2976 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2977 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2978 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2979 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2980 compressed using zlib.
2981
2982 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2983 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2984 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2985 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2986 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2987 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2988
2989 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2990 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2991
2992 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2993 zstd.
2994
2995 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2996 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2997 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2998 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2999
3000 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3001 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3002 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3003 @option{--help} option.
3004
3005 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3006 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
3007 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
3008 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
3009 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
3010 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3011
3012 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
3013 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
3014 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
3015 has been used.
3016
3017 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3018 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
3019
3020 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3021 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3022 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3023 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3024 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3025
3026 @kindex --build-id
3027 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3028 @item --build-id
3029 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
3030 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
3031 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
3032 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3033 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3034 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3035 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3036 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3037 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3038 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3039 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
3040
3041 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3042 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3043 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3044 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3045 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3046 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
3047
3048 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3049 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
3050
3051 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3052 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3053 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3054 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3055 specification. For more information see:
3056 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3057 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3058 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3059 occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
3060 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3061 will be validated.
3062 @end table
3063
3064 @c man end
3065
3066 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
3067
3068 @c man begin OPTIONS
3069
3070 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
3071 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3072 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3073 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3074 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3075 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3076 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3077 object file).
3078
3079 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
3080 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
3081 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3082 values by either a space or an equals sign.
3083
3084 @table @gcctabopt
3085
3086 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3087 @item --add-stdcall-alias
3088 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3089 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
3090 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3091
3092 @kindex --base-file
3093 @item --base-file @var{file}
3094 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3095 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3096 @file{dlltool}.
3097 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
3098
3099 @kindex --dll
3100 @item --dll
3101 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
3102 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
3103 file.
3104 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3105
3106 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
3107 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
3108 @item --enable-long-section-names
3109 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
3110 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
3111 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3112 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3113 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3114 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3115 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3116 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3117 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3118 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3119 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3120 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3121 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3122 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3123 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3124 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3125 image and not stripping symbols.
3126 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3127
3128 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3129 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3130 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3131 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3132 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3133 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3134 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3135 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3136 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3137 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3138 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3139 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3140 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3141 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3142 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3143 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3144 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3145 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3146
3147 @kindex --leading-underscore
3148 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3149 @item --leading-underscore
3150 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3151 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3152 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3153 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3154
3155 @cindex DLLs, creating
3156 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3157 @item --export-all-symbols
3158 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3159 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3160 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3161 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3162 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3163 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3164 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3165 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3166 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3167 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3168 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3169 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3170 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3171 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3172 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3173 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3174 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3175 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3176 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3177 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3178 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3179 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3180 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3181
3182 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3183 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3184 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3185 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3186 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3187
3188 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3189 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3190 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3191 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3192
3193 @kindex --file-alignment
3194 @item --file-alignment
3195 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3196 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3197 512.
3198 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3199
3200 @cindex heap size
3201 @kindex --heap
3202 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3203 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3204 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3205 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3206 committed.
3207 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3208
3209 @cindex image base
3210 @kindex --image-base
3211 @item --image-base @var{value}
3212 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3213 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3214 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3215 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3216 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3217 for dlls.
3218 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3219
3220 @kindex --kill-at
3221 @item --kill-at
3222 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3223 symbols before they are exported.
3224 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3225
3226 @kindex --large-address-aware
3227 @item --large-address-aware
3228 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3229 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3230 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3231 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3232 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3233 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3234
3235 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3236 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3237 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3238 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3239 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3240 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3241 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3242
3243 @kindex --major-image-version
3244 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3245 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3246 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3247
3248 @kindex --major-os-version
3249 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3250 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3251 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3252
3253 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3254 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3255 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3256 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3257
3258 @kindex --minor-image-version
3259 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3260 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3261 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3262
3263 @kindex --minor-os-version
3264 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3265 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3266 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3267
3268 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3269 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3270 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3271 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3272
3273 @cindex DEF files, creating
3274 @cindex DLLs, creating
3275 @kindex --output-def
3276 @item --output-def @var{file}
3277 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3278 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3279 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3280 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3281 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3282 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3283
3284 @cindex DLLs, creating
3285 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3286 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3287 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3288 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3289 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3290 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3291 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3292 execution are avoided.
3293 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3294
3295 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3296 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3297 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3298 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3299 default.
3300 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3301
3302 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3303 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3304 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3305 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3306 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3307 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3308 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3309 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3310 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3311 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3312
3313 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3314 @item --enable-auto-import
3315 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3316 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3317 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3318 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3319
3320 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3321 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3322
3323 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3324 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3325 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3326
3327 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3328 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3329 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3330 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3331 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3332
3333 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3334 see this message:
3335
3336 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3337 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3338
3339 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3340 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3341 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3342 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3343 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3344 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3345 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3346 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3347 the warning, and exit.
3348
3349 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3350 data type of the exported variable:
3351
3352 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3353 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3354 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3355
3356 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3357 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3358 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3359 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3360
3361 @example
3362 extern type extern_array[];
3363 extern_array[1] -->
3364 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3365 @end example
3366
3367 or
3368
3369 @example
3370 extern type extern_array[];
3371 extern_array[1] -->
3372 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3373 @end example
3374
3375 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3376 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3377
3378 @example
3379 extern struct s extern_struct;
3380 extern_struct.field -->
3381 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3382 @end example
3383
3384 or
3385
3386 @example
3387 extern long long extern_ll;
3388 extern_ll -->
3389 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3390 @end example
3391
3392 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3393 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3394 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3395 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3396 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3397 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3398 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3399 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3400
3401 Original:
3402 @example
3403 --foo.h
3404 extern int arr[];
3405 --foo.c
3406 #include "foo.h"
3407 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3408 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3409 @}
3410 @end example
3411
3412 Solution 1:
3413 @example
3414 --foo.h
3415 extern int arr[];
3416 --foo.c
3417 #include "foo.h"
3418 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3420 volatile int *parr = arr;
3421 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3422 @}
3423 @end example
3424
3425 Solution 2:
3426 @example
3427 --foo.h
3428 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3429 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3430 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3431 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3432 #else
3433 #define FOO_IMPORT
3434 #endif
3435 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3436 --foo.c
3437 #include "foo.h"
3438 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3439 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3440 @}
3441 @end example
3442
3443 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3444 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3445 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3446 functions).
3447
3448 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3449 @item --disable-auto-import
3450 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3451 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3452 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3453
3454 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3455 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3456 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3457 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3458 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3459 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3460 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3461
3462 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3463 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3464 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3465 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3466
3467 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3468 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3469 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3470 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3471
3472 @kindex --section-alignment
3473 @item --section-alignment
3474 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3475 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3476 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3477
3478 @cindex stack size
3479 @kindex --stack
3480 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3481 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3482 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3483 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3484 committed.
3485 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3486
3487 @kindex --subsystem
3488 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3489 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3490 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3491 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3492 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3493 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3494 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3495 @var{which}.
3496 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3497
3498 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3499 of the PE file header:
3500 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3501
3502 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3503 @item --high-entropy-va
3504 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3505 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3506 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3507
3508 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3509 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3510
3511 @kindex --dynamicbase
3512 @item --dynamicbase
3513 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3514 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3515 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3516 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3517 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3518 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3519
3520 @kindex --forceinteg
3521 @item --forceinteg
3522 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3523 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3524 default.
3525
3526 @kindex --nxcompat
3527 @item --nxcompat
3528 @item --disable-nxcompat
3529 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3530 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3531 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3532
3533 @kindex --no-isolation
3534 @item --no-isolation
3535 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3536 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3537 This option is disabled by default.
3538
3539 @kindex --no-seh
3540 @item --no-seh
3541 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3542 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3543 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3544
3545 @kindex --no-bind
3546 @item --no-bind
3547 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3548 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3549
3550 @kindex --wdmdriver
3551 @item --wdmdriver
3552 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3553 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3554 by default.
3555
3556 @kindex --tsaware
3557 @item --tsaware
3558 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3559 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3560 default.
3561
3562 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3563 @item --insert-timestamp
3564 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3565 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3566 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3567 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3568 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3569 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3570 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3571 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3572 identically.
3573
3574 If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3575 either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3576 @code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3577 of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3578
3579 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3580 @item --enable-reloc-section
3581 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3582 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3583 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3584 This option is enabled by default.
3585 @end table
3586
3587 @c man end
3588
3589 @ifset C6X
3590 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3591
3592 @c man begin OPTIONS
3593
3594 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3595 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3596 all executables use an index of 0.
3597
3598 @table @gcctabopt
3599
3600 @kindex --dsbt-size
3601 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3602 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3603 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3604 entries.
3605
3606 @kindex --dsbt-index
3607 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3608 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3609 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3610 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3611 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3612
3613 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3614 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3615 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3616
3617 @end table
3618
3619 @c man end
3620 @end ifset
3621
3622 @ifset CSKY
3623 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3624
3625 @c man begin OPTIONS
3626
3627 @table @gcctabopt
3628
3629 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3630 @item --branch-stub
3631 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3632 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3633 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3634 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3635 the compiler or assembler.
3636
3637 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3638 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3639 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3640 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3641 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3642 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3643 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3644 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3645 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3646
3647 @end table
3648
3649 @c man end
3650 @end ifset
3651
3652 @ifset M68HC11
3653 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3654
3655 @c man begin OPTIONS
3656
3657 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3658 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3659
3660 @table @gcctabopt
3661
3662 @kindex --no-trampoline
3663 @item --no-trampoline
3664 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3665 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3666 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3667
3668 @kindex --bank-window
3669 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3670 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3671 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3672 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3673 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3674
3675 @end table
3676
3677 @c man end
3678 @end ifset
3679
3680 @ifset M68K
3681 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3682
3683 @c man begin OPTIONS
3684
3685 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3686 when linking for 68K targets.
3687
3688 @table @gcctabopt
3689
3690 @kindex --got
3691 @item --got=@var{type}
3692 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3693 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3694 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3695 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3696
3697 @end table
3698
3699 @c man end
3700 @end ifset
3701
3702 @ifset MIPS
3703 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3704
3705 @c man begin OPTIONS
3706
3707 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3708 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3709 linking for MIPS targets.
3710
3711 @table @gcctabopt
3712
3713 @kindex --insn32
3714 @item --insn32
3715 @kindex --no-insn32
3716 @itemx --no-insn32
3717 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3718 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3719 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3720 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3721 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3722 possible.
3723
3724 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3725 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3726 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3727 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3728 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3729 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3730 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3731 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3732 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3733 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3734 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3735 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3736 an error.
3737
3738 @kindex --compact-branches
3739 @item --compact-branches
3740 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3741 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3742 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3743 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3744
3745 @end table
3746
3747 @c man end
3748 @end ifset
3749
3750
3751 @ifset PDP11
3752 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3753
3754 @c man begin OPTIONS
3755
3756 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3757 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3758 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3759 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3760 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3761 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3762
3763 @table @gcctabopt
3764
3765 @kindex -N
3766 @item -N
3767 @kindex --omagic
3768 @itemx --omagic
3769
3770 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3771 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3772 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3773 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3774 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3775 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3776 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3777
3778 @kindex -n
3779 @item -n
3780 @kindex --nmagic
3781 @itemx --nmagic
3782
3783 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3784 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3785 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3786 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3787 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3788 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3789
3790 @kindex -z
3791 @item -z
3792 @kindex --imagic
3793 @itemx --imagic
3794
3795 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3796 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3797 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3798 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3799 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3800 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3801 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3802 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3803 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3804 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3805 executable} format.
3806
3807 @kindex --no-omagic
3808 @item --no-omagic
3809
3810 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3811
3812 @end table
3813
3814 @c man end
3815 @end ifset
3816
3817 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3818 @node Environment
3819 @section Environment Variables
3820
3821 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3822
3823 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3824 @ifclear SingleFormat
3825 @code{GNUTARGET},
3826 @end ifclear
3827 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3828
3829 @ifclear SingleFormat
3830 @kindex GNUTARGET
3831 @cindex default input format
3832 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3833 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3834 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3835 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3836 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3837 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3838 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3839 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3840 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3841 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3842 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3843 @end ifclear
3844
3845 @kindex LDEMULATION
3846 @cindex default emulation
3847 @cindex emulation, default
3848 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3849 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3850 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3851 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3852 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3853 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3854 linker was configured.
3855
3856 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3857 @cindex demangling, default
3858 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3859 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3860 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3861 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3862 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3863 options.
3864
3865 @c man end
3866 @end ifset
3867
3868 @node Scripts
3869 @chapter Linker Scripts
3870
3871 @cindex scripts
3872 @cindex linker scripts
3873 @cindex command files
3874 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3875 written in the linker command language.
3876
3877 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3878 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3879 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3880 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3881 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3882 described below.
3883
3884 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3885 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3886 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3887 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3888 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3889
3890 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3891 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3892 default linker script.
3893
3894 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3895 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3896 Linker Scripts}.
3897
3898 @menu
3899 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3900 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3901 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3902 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3903 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3904 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3905 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3906 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3907 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3908 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3909 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3910 @end menu
3911
3912 @node Basic Script Concepts
3913 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3914 @cindex linker script concepts
3915 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3916 describe the linker script language.
3917
3918 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3919 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3920 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3921 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3922 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3923 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3924 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3925 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3926
3927 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3928 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3929 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3930 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3931 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3932 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3933 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3934 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3935 of debugging information.
3936
3937 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3938 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3939 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3940 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3941 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3942 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3943 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3944 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3945 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3946 RAM address would be the VMA.
3947
3948 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3949 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3950
3951 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3952 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3953 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3954 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3955 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3956 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3957 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3958
3959 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3960 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3961 option.
3962
3963 @node Script Format
3964 @section Linker Script Format
3965 @cindex linker script format
3966 Linker scripts are text files.
3967
3968 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3969 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3970 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3971 generally ignored.
3972
3973 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3974 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3975 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3976 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3977 file name.
3978
3979 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3980 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3981 to whitespace.
3982
3983 @node Simple Example
3984 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3985 @cindex linker script example
3986 @cindex example of linker script
3987 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3988
3989 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3990 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3991 memory layout of the output file.
3992
3993 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3994 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3995 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3996 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3997 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3998 your input files.
3999
4000 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
4001 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4002 linker script which will do that:
4003 @smallexample
4004 SECTIONS
4005 @{
4006 . = 0x10000;
4007 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4008 . = 0x8000000;
4009 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4010 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4011 @}
4012 @end smallexample
4013
4014 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4015 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4016 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4017
4018 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4019 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4020 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4021 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4022 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4023 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4024 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4025
4026 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4027 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4028 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4029 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4030 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4031 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4032
4033 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4034 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4035 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4036
4037 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4038 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4039 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4040 output section, the value of the location counter will be
4041 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4042 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
4043 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
4044
4045 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4046 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4047 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4048 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4049 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4050 sections.
4051
4052 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4053
4054 @node Simple Commands
4055 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
4056 @cindex linker script simple commands
4057 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4058
4059 @menu
4060 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4061 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4062 @ifclear SingleFormat
4063 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4064 @end ifclear
4065
4066 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
4067 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4068 @end menu
4069
4070 @node Entry Point
4071 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
4072 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4073 @cindex start of execution
4074 @cindex first instruction
4075 @cindex entry point
4076 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4077 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4078 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4079 @smallexample
4080 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4084 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4085 stopping when one of them succeeds:
4086 @itemize @bullet
4087 @item
4088 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
4089 @item
4090 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
4091 @item
4092 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
4093 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
4094 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
4095 @item
4096 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4097 executable is being created - the code section is usually
4098 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
4099 @item
4100 The address @code{0}.
4101 @end itemize
4102
4103 @node File Commands
4104 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
4105 @cindex linker script file commands
4106 Several linker script commands deal with files.
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4110 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4111 @cindex including a linker script
4112 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4113 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
4114 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
4115 10 levels deep.
4116
4117 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4118 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4119
4120 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4121 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4122 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4123 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4124 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4125 @cindex linker script input object files
4126 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4127 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4128
4129 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4130 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4131 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4132
4133 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4134 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4135
4136 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4137 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4138 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4139 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4140 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4141 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4142 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4143
4144 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4145 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4146 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4147 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4148 path.
4149
4150 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4151 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4152 @samp{-l}.
4153
4154 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4155 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4156 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4157
4158 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4159 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4160 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4161 @cindex grouping input files
4162 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4163 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4164 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4165 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4166
4167 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4168 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4169 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4170 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4171 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4172 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4173 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4174 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4175 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4176 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4177 setting afterwards.
4178
4179 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4180 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4181 @cindex output file name in linker script
4182 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4183 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4184 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4185 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4186 precedence.
4187
4188 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4189 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4190
4191 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4192 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4193 @cindex library search path in linker script
4194 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4195 @cindex search path in linker script
4196 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4197 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4198 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4199 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4200 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4201 the command-line option are searched first.
4202
4203 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4204 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4205 @cindex first input file
4206 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4207 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4208 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4209 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4210 first file.
4211 @end table
4212
4213 @ifclear SingleFormat
4214 @node Format Commands
4215 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4216 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4217
4218 @table @code
4219 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4220 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4221 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4222 @cindex output file format in linker script
4223 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4224 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4225 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4226 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4227 line option takes precedence.
4228
4229 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4230 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4231 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4232 desired endianness.
4233
4234 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4235 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4236 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4237 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4238
4239 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4240 command:
4241 @smallexample
4242 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4243 @end smallexample
4244 This says that the default format for the output file is
4245 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4246 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4247 format.
4248
4249 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4250 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4251 @cindex input file format in linker script
4252 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4253 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4254 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4255 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4256 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4257 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4258 @end table
4259 @end ifclear
4260
4261 @node REGION_ALIAS
4262 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4263 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4264 @cindex region alias
4265 @cindex region names
4266
4267 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4268 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4269
4270 @smallexample
4271 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4272 @end smallexample
4273
4274 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4275 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4276 to memory regions. An example follows.
4277
4278 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4279 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4280 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4281 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4282 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4283 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4284 sections:
4285
4286 @itemize @bullet
4287 @item
4288 @code{.text} program code;
4289 @item
4290 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4291 @item
4292 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4293 @item
4294 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4295 @end itemize
4296
4297 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4298 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4299 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4300 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4301 @code{C}:
4302 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4303 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4304 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4305 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4306 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4307 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4308 @end multitable
4309 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4310 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4311 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4312 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4313
4314 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4315 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4316 memory layout:
4317 @smallexample
4318 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4319
4320 SECTIONS
4321 @{
4322 .text :
4323 @{
4324 *(.text)
4325 @} > REGION_TEXT
4326 .rodata :
4327 @{
4328 *(.rodata)
4329 rodata_end = .;
4330 @} > REGION_RODATA
4331 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4332 @{
4333 data_start = .;
4334 *(.data)
4335 @} > REGION_DATA
4336 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4337 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4338 .bss :
4339 @{
4340 *(.bss)
4341 @} > REGION_BSS
4342 @}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4346 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4347 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4348 @table @code
4349 @item A
4350 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4351 @smallexample
4352 MEMORY
4353 @{
4354 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4355 @}
4356
4357 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4358 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4359 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4360 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4361 @end smallexample
4362 @item B
4363 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4364 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4365 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4366 @smallexample
4367 MEMORY
4368 @{
4369 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4370 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4371 @}
4372
4373 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4374 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4375 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4376 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4377 @end smallexample
4378 @item C
4379 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4380 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4381 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4382 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4383 @smallexample
4384 MEMORY
4385 @{
4386 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4387 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4388 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4389 @}
4390
4391 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4392 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4393 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4394 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4395 @end smallexample
4396 @end table
4397
4398 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4399 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4400 necessary:
4401 @smallexample
4402 #include <string.h>
4403
4404 extern char data_start [];
4405 extern char data_size [];
4406 extern char data_load_start [];
4407
4408 void copy_data(void)
4409 @{
4410 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4411 @{
4412 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4413 @}
4414 @}
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4418 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4419 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4420
4421 @table @code
4422 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4423 @kindex ASSERT
4424 @cindex assertion in linker script
4425 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4426 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4427
4428 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4429 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4430 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4431 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4432 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 .stack :
4436 @{
4437 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4438 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4439 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4440 @}
4441 @end smallexample
4442
4443 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4444 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4445 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4446
4447 @smallexample
4448 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4449 .stack :
4450 @{
4451 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4452 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4453 @}
4454 @end smallexample
4455
4456 will work.
4457
4458 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4459 @kindex EXTERN
4460 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4461 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4462 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4463 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4464 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4465 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4466
4467 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4468 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4469 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4470 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4471 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4472 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4473
4474 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4475 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4476 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4477 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4478 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4479 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4480
4481 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4482 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4483 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4484 @cindex section groups
4485 @cindex COMDAT
4486 This command has the same effect as the
4487 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4488 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4489 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4490 specified (@samp{-r}).
4491
4492 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4493 @kindex INSERT
4494 @cindex insert user script into default script
4495 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4496 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4497 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4498 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4499 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4500 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4501 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4502 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4503 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4504 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4505 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4506 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4507 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4508
4509 @smallexample
4510 SECTIONS
4511 @{
4512 OVERLAY :
4513 @{
4514 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4515 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4516 @}
4517 @}
4518 INSERT AFTER .text;
4519 @end smallexample
4520
4521 Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4522 script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4523 of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4524 The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4525 command line.
4526
4527 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4528 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4529 @cindex cross references
4530 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4531 references among certain output sections.
4532
4533 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4534 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4535 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4536 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4537 a function defined in the other section.
4538
4539 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4540 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4541 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4542 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4543 names.
4544
4545 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4546 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4547 @cindex cross references
4548 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4549 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4550
4551 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4552 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4553 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4554 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4555 must never call back.
4556
4557 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4558 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4559 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4560 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4561 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4562 names, not input section names.
4563
4564 @ifclear SingleFormat
4565 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4566 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4567 @cindex machine architecture
4568 @cindex architecture
4569 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4570 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4571 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4572 the @samp{-f} option.
4573 @end ifclear
4574
4575 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4576 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4577 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4578 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4579 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4580 @xref{Expression Section}.
4581 @end table
4582
4583 @node Assignments
4584 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4585 @cindex assignment in scripts
4586 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4587 @cindex variables, defining
4588 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4589 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4590
4591 @menu
4592 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4593 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4594 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4595 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4596 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4597 @end menu
4598
4599 @node Simple Assignments
4600 @subsection Simple Assignments
4601
4602 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4603
4604 @table @code
4605 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4606 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4607 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4608 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4609 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4610 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4611 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4612 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4613 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4614 @end table
4615
4616 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4617 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4618 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4619
4620 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4621 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4622
4623 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4624
4625 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4626
4627 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4628 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4629 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4630
4631 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4632 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4633
4634 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4635 assignments may be used:
4636
4637 @smallexample
4638 floating_point = 0;
4639 SECTIONS
4640 @{
4641 .text :
4642 @{
4643 *(.text)
4644 _etext = .;
4645 @}
4646 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4647 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4648 @}
4649 @end smallexample
4650 @noindent
4651 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4652 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4653 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4654 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4655 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4656
4657 @node HIDDEN
4658 @subsection HIDDEN
4659 @cindex HIDDEN
4660 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4661 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4662
4663 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4664 @code{HIDDEN}:
4665
4666 @smallexample
4667 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4668 SECTIONS
4669 @{
4670 .text :
4671 @{
4672 *(.text)
4673 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4674 @}
4675 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4676 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4677 @}
4678 @end smallexample
4679 @noindent
4680 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4681
4682 @node PROVIDE
4683 @subsection PROVIDE
4684 @cindex PROVIDE
4685 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4686 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4687 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4688 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4689 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4690 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4691 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4692 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4693
4694 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4695 @smallexample
4696 SECTIONS
4697 @{
4698 .text :
4699 @{
4700 *(.text)
4701 _etext = .;
4702 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4703 @}
4704 @}
4705 @end smallexample
4706
4707 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4708 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4709 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4710 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4711 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4712 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4713
4714 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4715 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4716 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4717 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4718 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4719
4720 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4721 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4722 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4723 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4724 hidden and won't be exported.
4725
4726 @node Source Code Reference
4727 @subsection Source Code Reference
4728
4729 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4730 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4731 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4732 symbol that does not have a value.
4733
4734 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4735 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4736 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4737 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4738 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4739 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4740 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4741 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4742
4743 @smallexample
4744 extern int foo;
4745 @end smallexample
4746
4747 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4748
4749 @smallexample
4750 _foo = 1000;
4751 @end smallexample
4752
4753 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4754 transformation has taken place.
4755
4756 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4757 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4758 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4759 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4760 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4761 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4762 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4763
4764 @smallexample
4765 int foo = 1000;
4766 @end smallexample
4767
4768 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4769 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4770 number 1000 is initially stored.
4771
4772 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4773 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4774 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4775 So:
4776
4777 @smallexample
4778 foo = 1;
4779 @end smallexample
4780
4781 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4782 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4783 address. Whereas:
4784
4785 @smallexample
4786 int * a = & foo;
4787 @end smallexample
4788
4789 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4790 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4791 the variable @samp{a}.
4792
4793 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4794 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4795 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4796
4797 @smallexample
4798 foo = 1000;
4799 @end smallexample
4800
4801 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4802 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4803 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4804 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4805 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4806
4807 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4808 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4809 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4810 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4811 linker script contains these declarations:
4812
4813 @smallexample
4814 @group
4815 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4816 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4817 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4818 @end group
4819 @end smallexample
4820
4821 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4822
4823 @smallexample
4824 @group
4825 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4826
4827 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4828 @end group
4829 @end smallexample
4830
4831 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4832 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4833 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4834
4835 @smallexample
4836 @group
4837 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4838
4839 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4840 @end group
4841 @end smallexample
4842
4843 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4844 operators.
4845
4846 @node SECTIONS
4847 @section SECTIONS Command
4848 @kindex SECTIONS
4849 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4850 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4851
4852 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4853 @smallexample
4854 SECTIONS
4855 @{
4856 @var{sections-command}
4857 @var{sections-command}
4858 @dots{}
4859 @}
4860 @end smallexample
4861
4862 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4863
4864 @itemize @bullet
4865 @item
4866 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4867 @item
4868 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4869 @item
4870 an output section description
4871 @item
4872 an overlay description
4873 @end itemize
4874
4875 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4876 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4877 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4878 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4879 the layout of the output file.
4880
4881 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4882 below.
4883
4884 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4885 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4886 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4887 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4888 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4889 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4890
4891 @menu
4892 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4893 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4894 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4895 * Input Section:: Input section description
4896 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4897 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4898 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4899 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4900 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4901 @end menu
4902
4903 @node Output Section Description
4904 @subsection Output Section Description
4905 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4906 @smallexample
4907 @group
4908 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4909 [AT(@var{lma})]
4910 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4911 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4912 [@var{constraint}]
4913 @{
4914 @var{output-section-command}
4915 @var{output-section-command}
4916 @dots{}
4917 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4918 @end group
4919 @end smallexample
4920
4921 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4922
4923 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4924 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4925 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4926 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4927 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4928
4929 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4930
4931 @itemize @bullet
4932 @item
4933 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4934 @item
4935 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4936 @item
4937 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4938 @item
4939 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4940 @end itemize
4941
4942 @node Output Section Name
4943 @subsection Output Section Name
4944 @cindex name, section
4945 @cindex section name
4946 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4947 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4948 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4949 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4950 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4951 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4952 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4953 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4954 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4955 commas must be quoted.
4956
4957 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4958 Discarding}.
4959
4960 @node Output Section Address
4961 @subsection Output Section Address
4962 @cindex address, section
4963 @cindex section address
4964 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4965 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4966 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4967
4968 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4969 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4970 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4971 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4972 contained within the output section.
4973
4974 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4975
4976 @itemize @bullet
4977 @item
4978 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4979 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4980 in that region.
4981
4982 @item
4983 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4984 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4985 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4986 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4987
4988 @item
4989 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4990 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4991 counter.
4992 @end itemize
4993
4994 @noindent
4995 For example:
4996
4997 @smallexample
4998 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4999 @end smallexample
5000
5001 @noindent
5002 and
5003
5004 @smallexample
5005 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @noindent
5009 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5010 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5011 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
5012 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5013 input sections.
5014
5015 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5016 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5017 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5018 do something like this:
5019 @smallexample
5020 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5021 @end smallexample
5022 @noindent
5023 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5024 aligned upward to the specified value.
5025
5026 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
5027 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5028 sections are ignored).
5029
5030 @node Input Section
5031 @subsection Input Section Description
5032 @cindex input sections
5033 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5034 The most common output section command is an input section description.
5035
5036 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5037 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5038 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5039 map the input files into your memory layout.
5040
5041 @menu
5042 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5043 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5044 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5045 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5046 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
5047 @end menu
5048
5049 @node Input Section Basics
5050 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
5051 @cindex input section basics
5052 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5053 by a list of section names in parentheses.
5054
5055 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5056 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5057
5058 The most common input section description is to include all input
5059 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5060 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5061 @smallexample
5062 *(.text)
5063 @end smallexample
5064 @noindent
5065 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
5066 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
5067 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5068 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5069 example:
5070 @smallexample
5071 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5072 @end smallexample
5073 @noindent
5074 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5075 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5076 placed inside the section list, for example:
5077 @smallexample
5078 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
5079 @end smallexample
5080 @noindent
5081 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5082 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5083 more than one section, as described below.
5084
5085 There are two ways to include more than one section:
5086 @smallexample
5087 *(.text .rdata)
5088 *(.text) *(.rdata)
5089 @end smallexample
5090 @noindent
5091 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5092 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
5093 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5094 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
5095 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5096 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
5097
5098 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5099 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5100 immediately following section, for example:
5101 @smallexample
5102 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5103 @end smallexample
5104 @noindent
5105 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5106 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5107 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5108 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
5109 could be modified to:
5110 @smallexample
5111 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5112 @end smallexample
5113 @noindent
5114 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5115 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5116 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5117 @smallexample
5118 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5119 @end smallexample
5120
5121 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5122 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5123 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5124 @smallexample
5125 data.o(.data)
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5129 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5130
5131 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5132
5133 @smallexample
5134 @group
5135 SECTIONS @{
5136 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5137 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5138 @}
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5143 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5144 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5145 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5146 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5147
5148 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5149 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5150 with no whitespace around the colon.
5151
5152 @table @samp
5153 @item archive:file
5154 matches file within archive
5155 @item archive:
5156 matches the whole archive
5157 @item :file
5158 matches file but not one in an archive
5159 @end table
5160
5161 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5162 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5163 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5164 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5165 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5166 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5167 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5168 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5169 command.
5170
5171 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5172 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5173 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5174 @smallexample
5175 data.o
5176 @end smallexample
5177
5178 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5179 and does not contain any wild card
5180 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5181 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5182 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5183 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5184 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5185 the archive search path.
5186
5187 @node Input Section Wildcards
5188 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5189 @cindex input section wildcards
5190 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5191 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5192 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5193 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5194 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5195
5196 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5197 pattern for the file name.
5198
5199 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5200
5201 @table @samp
5202 @item *
5203 matches any number of characters
5204 @item ?
5205 matches any single character
5206 @item [@var{chars}]
5207 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5208 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5209 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5210 @item \
5211 quotes the following character
5212 @end table
5213
5214 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5215 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5216 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5217
5218 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5219 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5220 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5221 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5222 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5223 @smallexample
5224 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5225 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5226 @end smallexample
5227
5228 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5229 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5230 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5231 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5232 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5233 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5234 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5235
5236 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5237 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5238 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5239 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5240 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5241 needed.
5242
5243 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5244 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5245 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5246 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5247 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5248 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5249 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5250 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5251
5252 @cindex SORT
5253 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5254
5255 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5256 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5257
5258 @enumerate
5259 @item
5260 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5261 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5262 sections have the same name.
5263 @item
5264 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5265 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5266 sections have the same alignment.
5267 @item
5268 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5269 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5270 @item
5271 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5272 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5273 @item
5274 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5275 @end enumerate
5276
5277 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5278 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5279 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5280
5281 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5282 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5283 treated as nested sorting command.
5284
5285 @enumerate
5286 @item
5287 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5288 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5289 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5290 @item
5291 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5292 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5293 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5294 @end enumerate
5295
5296 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5297 command-line option will be ignored.
5298
5299 @cindex SORT_NONE
5300 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5301 section sorting option.
5302
5303 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5304 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5305 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5306
5307 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5308 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5309 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5310 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5311 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5312 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5313 @smallexample
5314 @group
5315 SECTIONS @{
5316 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5317 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5318 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5319 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5320 @}
5321 @end group
5322 @end smallexample
5323
5324 @node Input Section Common
5325 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5326 @cindex common symbol placement
5327 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5328 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5329 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5330 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5331 named @samp{COMMON}.
5332
5333 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5334 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5335 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5336 input files are placed in another section.
5337
5338 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5339 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5340 @smallexample
5341 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5342 @end smallexample
5343
5344 @cindex scommon section
5345 @cindex small common symbols
5346 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5347 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5348 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5349 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5350 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5351 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5352 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5353 locations.
5354
5355 @cindex [COMMON]
5356 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5357 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5358 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5359
5360 @node Input Section Keep
5361 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5362 @cindex KEEP
5363 @cindex garbage collection
5364 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5365 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5366 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5367 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5368 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5369
5370 @node Input Section Example
5371 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5372 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5373 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5374 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5375 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5376 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5377 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5378 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5379 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5380 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5381
5382 @smallexample
5383 @group
5384 SECTIONS @{
5385 outputa 0x10000 :
5386 @{
5387 all.o
5388 foo.o (.input1)
5389 @}
5390 @end group
5391 @group
5392 outputb :
5393 @{
5394 foo.o (.input2)
5395 foo1.o (.input1)
5396 @}
5397 @end group
5398 @group
5399 outputc :
5400 @{
5401 *(.input1)
5402 *(.input2)
5403 @}
5404 @}
5405 @end group
5406 @end smallexample
5407
5408 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5409 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5410 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5411 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5412 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5413 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5414 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5415
5416 @node Output Section Data
5417 @subsection Output Section Data
5418 @cindex data
5419 @cindex section data
5420 @cindex output section data
5421 @kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
5422 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5423 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5424 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5425 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5426 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5427 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5428 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5429 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5430 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5431 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5432 counter.
5433
5434 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5435 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5436 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5437 stored.
5438
5439 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5440 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5441 @smallexample
5442 BYTE(1)
5443 LONG(addr)
5444 @end smallexample
5445
5446 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5447 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5448 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5449 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5450 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5451
5452 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5453 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5454 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5455 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5456 endianness of the first input object file.
5457
5458 You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5459 @code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5460 the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5461 end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5462 quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5463 Hex numbers are not supported.
5464
5465 For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5466 @smallexample
5467 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5468 @end smallexample
5469
5470 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5471 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5472 @smallexample
5473 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5474 @end smallexample
5475 whereas this will work:
5476 @smallexample
5477 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5478 @end smallexample
5479
5480 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5481 @cindex holes, filling
5482 @cindex unspecified memory
5483 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5484 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5485 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5486 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5487 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5488 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5489 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5490 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5491 different parts of an output section.
5492
5493 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5494 value @samp{0x90}:
5495 @smallexample
5496 FILL(0x90909090)
5497 @end smallexample
5498
5499 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5500 section attribute, but it only affects the
5501 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5502 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5503 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5504 expression.
5505
5506 @kindex LINKER_VERSION
5507 @cindex LINKER_VERSION
5508 Inserts a string containing the version of the linker at the current
5509 point. Note - by default this directive is disabled and will do
5510 nothing. It only becomes active if the
5511 @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5512
5513 Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5514 directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5515
5516 @node Output Section Keywords
5517 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5518 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5519 commands.
5520
5521 @table @code
5522 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5523 @cindex input filename symbols
5524 @cindex filename symbols
5525 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5526 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5527 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5528 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5529 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5530
5531 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5532 normally used for any other object file format.
5533
5534 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5535 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5536 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5537 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5538 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5539 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5540 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5541 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5542 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5543 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5544 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5545 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5546 ignored for other object file formats.
5547
5548 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5549 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5550 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5551 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5552 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5553 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5554 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5555 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5556 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5557 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5558 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5559 @code{exit}.
5560
5561 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5562 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5563 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5564 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5565 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5566 runtime code expects to see.
5567
5568 @smallexample
5569 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5570 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5571 *(.ctors)
5572 LONG(0)
5573 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5574 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5575 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5576 *(.dtors)
5577 LONG(0)
5578 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5579 @end smallexample
5580
5581 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5582 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5583 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5584 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5585 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5586 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5587 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5588 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5589
5590 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5591 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5592 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5593 scripts.
5594
5595 @end table
5596
5597 @node Output Section Discarding
5598 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5599 @cindex discarding sections
5600 @cindex sections, discarding
5601 @cindex removing sections
5602 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5603 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5604 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5605 @smallexample
5606 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5607 @end smallexample
5608 @noindent
5609 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5610 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5611 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5612 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5613 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5614 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5615 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5616 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5617 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5618
5619 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5620 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5621 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5622 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5623 section is discarded.
5624
5625 @cindex /DISCARD/
5626 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5627 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5628 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5629
5630 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5631 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5632 garbage collection.
5633
5634 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5635 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5636 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5637 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5638
5639 @node Output Section Attributes
5640 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5641 @cindex output section attributes
5642 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5643 like this:
5644
5645 @smallexample
5646 @group
5647 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5648 [AT(@var{lma})]
5649 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5650 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5651 [@var{constraint}]
5652 @{
5653 @var{output-section-command}
5654 @var{output-section-command}
5655 @dots{}
5656 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5657 @end group
5658 @end smallexample
5659
5660 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5661 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5662 remaining section attributes.
5663
5664 @menu
5665 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5666 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5667 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5668 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5669 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5670 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5671 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5672 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5673 @end menu
5674
5675 @node Output Section Type
5676 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5677 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5678 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5679
5680 @table @code
5681
5682 @item NOLOAD
5683 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5684 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5685
5686 @item READONLY
5687 The section should be marked as read-only.
5688
5689 @item DSECT
5690 @item COPY
5691 @item INFO
5692 @item OVERLAY
5693 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5694 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5695 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5696 section when the program is run.
5697
5698 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5699 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5700 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5701 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5702 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5703 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5704 special requirements of the section type are met.
5705
5706 Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5707 section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5708 @smallexample
5709 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5710 @end smallexample
5711 will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5712 @samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5713 type. Whereas:
5714 @smallexample
5715 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5716 @end smallexample
5717 will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5718 to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5719 type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5720 @smallexample
5721 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5722 @end smallexample
5723
5724 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5725 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5726 type specified by @var{type}.
5727
5728 @end table
5729
5730 @kindex NOLOAD
5731 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5732 @cindex loading, preventing
5733 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5734 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5735 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5736 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5737 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5738 @smallexample
5739 @group
5740 SECTIONS @{
5741 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5742 @dots{}
5743 @}
5744 @end group
5745 @end smallexample
5746
5747 @node Output Section LMA
5748 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5749 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5750 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5751 @cindex load address
5752 @cindex section load address
5753 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5754 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5755 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5756 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5757 address is optional.
5758
5759 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5760 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5761 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5762 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5763 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5764
5765 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5766 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5767 load address:
5768
5769 @itemize @bullet
5770 @item
5771 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5772 the LMA address as well.
5773
5774 @item
5775 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5776
5777 @item
5778 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5779 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5780 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5781 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5782 the last section in the located region.
5783
5784 @item
5785 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5786 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5787
5788 @item
5789 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5790 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5791 @end itemize
5792
5793 @cindex ROM initialized data
5794 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5795 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5796 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5797 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5798 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5799 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5800 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5801 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5802 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 @group
5806 SECTIONS
5807 @{
5808 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5809 .mdata 0x2000 :
5810 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5811 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5812 .bss 0x3000 :
5813 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5814 @}
5815 @end group
5816 @end smallexample
5817
5818 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5819 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5820 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5821 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5822 script.
5823
5824 @smallexample
5825 @group
5826 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5827 char *src = &_etext;
5828 char *dst = &_data;
5829
5830 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5831 while (dst < &_edata)
5832 *dst++ = *src++;
5833
5834 /* Zero bss. */
5835 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5836 *dst = 0;
5837 @end group
5838 @end smallexample
5839
5840 @node Forced Output Alignment
5841 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5842 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5843 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5844 @cindex output section alignment
5845 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5846 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5847 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5848
5849 @node Forced Input Alignment
5850 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5851 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5852 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5853 @cindex input section alignment
5854 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5855 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5856 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5857
5858 @node Output Section Constraint
5859 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5860 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5861 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5862 @cindex constraints on output sections
5863 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5864 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5865 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5866 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5867
5868 @node Output Section Region
5869 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5870 @kindex >@var{region}
5871 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5872 @cindex memory regions and sections
5873 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5874 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5875
5876 Here is a simple example:
5877 @smallexample
5878 @group
5879 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5880 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5881 @end group
5882 @end smallexample
5883
5884 @node Output Section Phdr
5885 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5886 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5887 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5888 @cindex program headers and sections
5889 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5890 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5891 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5892 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5893 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5894 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5895
5896 Here is a simple example:
5897 @smallexample
5898 @group
5899 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5900 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5901 @end group
5902 @end smallexample
5903
5904 @node Output Section Fill
5905 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5906 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5907 @cindex section fill pattern
5908 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5909 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5910 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5911 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5912 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5913 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5914 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5915 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5916 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5917 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5918 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5919 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5920 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5921
5922 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5923 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5924
5925 Here is a simple example:
5926 @smallexample
5927 @group
5928 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5929 @end group
5930 @end smallexample
5931
5932 @node Overlay Description
5933 @subsection Overlay Description
5934 @kindex OVERLAY
5935 @cindex overlays
5936 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5937 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5938 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5939 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5940 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5941 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5942 than another.
5943
5944 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5945 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5946 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5947 command is as follows:
5948 @smallexample
5949 @group
5950 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5951 @{
5952 @var{secname1}
5953 @{
5954 @var{output-section-command}
5955 @var{output-section-command}
5956 @dots{}
5957 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5958 @var{secname2}
5959 @{
5960 @var{output-section-command}
5961 @var{output-section-command}
5962 @dots{}
5963 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5964 @dots{}
5965 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5966 @end group
5967 @end smallexample
5968
5969 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5970 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5971 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5972 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5973 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5974 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5975
5976 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5977 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5978
5979 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5980 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5981 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5982 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5983 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5984 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5985
5986 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5987 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5988 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5989 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5990 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5991
5992 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5993 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5994 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5995 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5996 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5997 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5998 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5999
6000 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6001 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6002
6003 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6004 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
6005 @smallexample
6006 @group
6007 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6008 @{
6009 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6010 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6011 @}
6012 @end group
6013 @end smallexample
6014 @noindent
6015 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6016 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6017 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
6018 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
6019 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6020 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
6021
6022 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6023 like the following.
6024
6025 @smallexample
6026 @group
6027 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6028 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6029 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6030 @end group
6031 @end smallexample
6032
6033 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6034 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6035 example could have been written identically as follows.
6036
6037 @smallexample
6038 @group
6039 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6040 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6041 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
6042 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6043 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6044 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
6045 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6046 @end group
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 @node MEMORY
6050 @section MEMORY Command
6051 @kindex MEMORY
6052 @cindex memory regions
6053 @cindex regions of memory
6054 @cindex allocating memory
6055 @cindex discontinuous memory
6056 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6057 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6058
6059 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6060 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6061 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6062 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6063 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6064 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6065 around to fit into the available regions.
6066
6067 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6068 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6069 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6070 @code{MEMORY} is:
6071 @smallexample
6072 @group
6073 MEMORY
6074 @{
6075 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6076 @dots{}
6077 @}
6078 @end group
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6082 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6083 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6084 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
6085 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6086 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
6087 command.
6088
6089 @cindex memory region attributes
6090 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6091 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6092 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6093 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6094 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6095 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6096 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6097
6098 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6099 @table @samp
6100 @item R
6101 Read-only section
6102 @item W
6103 Read/write section
6104 @item X
6105 Executable section
6106 @item A
6107 Allocatable section
6108 @item I
6109 Initialized section
6110 @item L
6111 Same as @samp{I}
6112 @item !
6113 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
6114 @end table
6115
6116 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
6117 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
6118 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6119 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6120 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6121 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6122 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6123 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
6124
6125 @kindex ORIGIN =
6126 @kindex o =
6127 @kindex org =
6128 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6129 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6130 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6131 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6132 @code{ORG}).
6133
6134 @kindex LENGTH =
6135 @kindex len =
6136 @kindex l =
6137 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6138 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
6139 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6140 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
6141
6142 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6143 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6144 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6145 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6146 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6147 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6148 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6149 region.
6150
6151 @smallexample
6152 @group
6153 MEMORY
6154 @{
6155 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6156 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6157 @}
6158 @end group
6159 @end smallexample
6160
6161 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6162 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6163 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6164 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6165 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6166 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6167 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6168 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6169 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6170
6171 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6172 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6173 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6174
6175 @smallexample
6176 @group
6177 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6178 @end group
6179 @end smallexample
6180
6181 @node PHDRS
6182 @section PHDRS Command
6183 @kindex PHDRS
6184 @cindex program headers
6185 @cindex ELF program headers
6186 @cindex program segments
6187 @cindex segments, ELF
6188 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6189 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6190 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6191 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6192
6193 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6194 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6195 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6196 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6197 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6198
6199 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6200 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6201 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6202 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6203 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6204
6205 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6206 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6207 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6208
6209 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6210 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6211
6212 @smallexample
6213 @group
6214 PHDRS
6215 @{
6216 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6217 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6218 @}
6219 @end group
6220 @end smallexample
6221
6222 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6223 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6224 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6225 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6226 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6227 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6228
6229 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6230 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6231 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6232 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6233 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6234 Section Phdr}.
6235
6236 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6237 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6238 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6239 contain the section.
6240
6241 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6242 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6243 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6244 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6245 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6246 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6247 segment at all.
6248
6249 @kindex FILEHDR
6250 @kindex PHDRS
6251 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6252 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6253 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6254 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6255 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6256 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6257 these keywords.
6258
6259 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6260 value of the keyword.
6261
6262 @table @asis
6263 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6264 Indicates an unused program header.
6265
6266 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6267 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6268 the file.
6269
6270 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6271 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6272
6273 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6274 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6275 found.
6276
6277 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6278 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6279
6280 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6281 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6282 ABI.
6283
6284 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6285 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6286
6287 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6288 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6289
6290 @item @var{expression}
6291 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6292 be used for types not defined above.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6296 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6297 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6298 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6299 output section attribute.
6300
6301 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6302 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6303 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6304 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6305 header.
6306
6307 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6308 headers used on a native ELF system.
6309
6310 @example
6311 @group
6312 PHDRS
6313 @{
6314 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6315 interp PT_INTERP ;
6316 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6317 data PT_LOAD ;
6318 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6319 @}
6320
6321 SECTIONS
6322 @{
6323 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6324 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6325 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6326 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6327 @dots{}
6328 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6329 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6330 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6331 @dots{}
6332 @}
6333 @end group
6334 @end example
6335
6336 @node VERSION
6337 @section VERSION Command
6338 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6339 @cindex symbol versions
6340 @cindex version script
6341 @cindex versions of symbols
6342 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6343 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6344 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6345 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6346 shared library.
6347
6348 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6349 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6350 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6351
6352 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6353 @smallexample
6354 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6355 @end smallexample
6356
6357 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6358 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6359 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6360 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6361 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6362 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6363 library.
6364
6365 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6366 examples.
6367
6368 @smallexample
6369 VERS_1.1 @{
6370 global:
6371 foo1;
6372 local:
6373 old*;
6374 original*;
6375 new*;
6376 @};
6377
6378 VERS_1.2 @{
6379 foo2;
6380 @} VERS_1.1;
6381
6382 VERS_2.0 @{
6383 bar1; bar2;
6384 extern "C++" @{
6385 ns::*;
6386 "f(int, double)";
6387 @};
6388 @} VERS_1.2;
6389 @end smallexample
6390
6391 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6392 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6393 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6394 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6395 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6396 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6397 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6398 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6399 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6400 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6401
6402 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6403 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6404 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6405
6406 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6407 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6408 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6409
6410 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6411 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6412 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6413 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6414 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6415 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6416 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6417 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6418 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6419
6420 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6421 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6422 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6423 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6424
6425 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6426 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6427 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6428 won't.
6429
6430 @smallexample
6431 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6432 @end smallexample
6433
6434 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6435 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6436 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6437 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6438 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6439 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6440 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6441 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6442 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6443 search for each symbol reference.
6444
6445 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6446 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6447 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6448 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6449 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6450 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6451 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6452 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6453 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6454
6455 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6456 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6457 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6458 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6459 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6460 @smallexample
6461 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6462 @end smallexample
6463 @noindent
6464 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6465 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6466 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6467 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6468 takes precedence over a version script.
6469
6470 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6471 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6472 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6473 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6474 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6475
6476 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6477 source file. Here is an example:
6478
6479 @smallexample
6480 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6481 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6482 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6483 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6484 @end smallexample
6485
6486 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6487 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6488 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6489 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6490
6491 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6492 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6493 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6494 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6495 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6496 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6497
6498 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6499 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6500 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6501 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6502
6503 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6504
6505 @smallexample
6506 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6510 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6511 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6512 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6513 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6514
6515 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6516 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6517 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6518 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6519 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6520 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6521 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6522 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6523 expect when you upgrade.
6524
6525 @node Expressions
6526 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6527 @cindex expressions
6528 @cindex arithmetic
6529 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6530 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6531 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6532 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6533 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6534 otherwise 64 bits.
6535
6536 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6537
6538 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6539 expressions.
6540
6541 @menu
6542 * Constants:: Constants
6543 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6544 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6545 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6546 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6547 * Operators:: Operators
6548 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6549 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6550 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6551 @end menu
6552
6553 @node Constants
6554 @subsection Constants
6555 @cindex integer notation
6556 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6557 All constants are integers.
6558
6559 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6560 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6561 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6562 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6563 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6564 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6565
6566 @cindex scaled integers
6567 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6568 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6569 @cindex suffixes for integers
6570 @cindex integer suffixes
6571 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6572 constant by
6573 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6574 @ifnottex
6575 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6576 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6577 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6578 @end ifnottex
6579 @tex
6580 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6581 @end tex
6582 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6583 respectively. For example, the following
6584 all refer to the same quantity:
6585
6586 @smallexample
6587 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6588 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6589 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6590 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6591 @end smallexample
6592
6593 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6594 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6595
6596 @node Symbolic Constants
6597 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6598 @cindex symbolic constants
6599 @kindex CONSTANT
6600 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6601 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6602
6603 @table @code
6604 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6605 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6606 The target's maximum page size.
6607
6608 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6609 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6610 The target's default page size.
6611 @end table
6612
6613 So for example:
6614
6615 @smallexample
6616 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6617 @end smallexample
6618
6619 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6620 supported by the target.
6621
6622 @node Symbols
6623 @subsection Symbol Names
6624 @cindex symbol names
6625 @cindex names
6626 @cindex quoted symbol names
6627 @kindex "
6628 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6629 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6630 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6631 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6632 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6633 @smallexample
6634 "SECTION" = 9;
6635 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6636 @end smallexample
6637
6638 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6639 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6640 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6641
6642 @node Orphan Sections
6643 @subsection Orphan Sections
6644 @cindex orphan
6645 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6646 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6647 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6648 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6649 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6650
6651 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6652 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6653 placed at the end of that output section.
6654
6655 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6656 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6657 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6658 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6659 one new output section.
6660
6661 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6662 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6663 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6664 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6665 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6666 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6667 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6668
6669 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6670 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6671 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6672
6673 @node Location Counter
6674 @subsection The Location Counter
6675 @kindex .
6676 @cindex dot
6677 @cindex location counter
6678 @cindex current output location
6679 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6680 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6681 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6682 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6683 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6684
6685 @cindex holes
6686 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6687 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6688 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6689 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6690 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6691
6692 @smallexample
6693 SECTIONS
6694 @{
6695 output :
6696 @{
6697 file1(.text)
6698 . = . + 1000;
6699 file2(.text)
6700 . += 1000;
6701 file3(.text)
6702 @} = 0x12345678;
6703 @}
6704 @end smallexample
6705 @noindent
6706 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6707 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6708 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6709 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6710 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6711 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6712
6713 @cindex dot inside sections
6714 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6715 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6716 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6717 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6718 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6719 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6720
6721 @smallexample
6722 SECTIONS
6723 @{
6724 . = 0x100
6725 .text: @{
6726 *(.text)
6727 . = 0x200
6728 @}
6729 . = 0x500
6730 .data: @{
6731 *(.data)
6732 . += 0x600
6733 @}
6734 @}
6735 @end smallexample
6736
6737 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6738 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6739 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6740 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6741 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6742 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6743 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6744 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6745
6746 @cindex dot outside sections
6747 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6748 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6749 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6750
6751 @smallexample
6752 SECTIONS
6753 @{
6754 start_of_text = . ;
6755 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6756 end_of_text = . ;
6757
6758 start_of_data = . ;
6759 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6760 end_of_data = . ;
6761 @}
6762 @end smallexample
6763
6764 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6765 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6766 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6767 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6768 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6769 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6770 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6771 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6772 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6773 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6774 as follows:
6775
6776 @smallexample
6777 SECTIONS
6778 @{
6779 start_of_text = . ;
6780 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6781 end_of_text = . ;
6782
6783 start_of_data = . ;
6784 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6785 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6786 end_of_data = . ;
6787 @}
6788 @end smallexample
6789
6790 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6791 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6792 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6793 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6794 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6795 section. So you could write:
6796
6797 @smallexample
6798 SECTIONS
6799 @{
6800 start_of_text = . ;
6801 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6802 end_of_text = . ;
6803
6804 . = . ;
6805 start_of_data = . ;
6806 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6807 end_of_data = . ;
6808 @}
6809 @end smallexample
6810
6811 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6812 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6813
6814 @need 2000
6815 @node Operators
6816 @subsection Operators
6817 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6818 @cindex arithmetic operators
6819 @cindex precedence in expressions
6820 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6821 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6822 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6823 @ifnottex
6824 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6825 @smallexample
6826 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6827 (highest)
6828 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6829 2 left * / %
6830 3 left + -
6831 4 left >> <<
6832 5 left > < <= >=
6833 6 left == !=
6834 7 left &
6835 8 left ^
6836 9 left |
6837 10 left &&
6838 11 left ||
6839 12 right ? :
6840 13 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
6841 (lowest)
6842 @end smallexample
6843 Notes:
6844 (1) Prefix operators
6845 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6846 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6847 @end ifnottex
6848 @tex
6849 \vskip \baselineskip
6850 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6851 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6852 \hrule
6853 \halign
6854 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6855 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6856 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6857 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6858 \noalign{\hrule}
6859 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6860 &highest&&&&&\cr
6861 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6862 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6863 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6864 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6865 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6866 &5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6867 &6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6868 &7&&left&&\&&\cr
6869 &8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
6870 &9&&left&&|&\cr
6871 &10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6872 &11&&left&&||&\cr
6873 &12&&right&&? :&\cr
6874 &13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6875 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6876 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6877 \hrule}
6878 @end tex
6879 @iftex
6880 {
6881 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6882 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6883 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6884 }
6885 @end iftex
6886 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6887
6888 @node Evaluation
6889 @subsection Evaluation
6890 @cindex lazy evaluation
6891 @cindex expression evaluation order
6892 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6893 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6894
6895 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6896 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6897 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6898 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6899
6900 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6901 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6902 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6903 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6904
6905 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6906 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6907 allocation.
6908
6909 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6910 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6911
6912 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6913 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6914 following
6915 @smallexample
6916 @group
6917 SECTIONS
6918 @{
6919 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6920 @{ *(.text) @}
6921 @}
6922 @end group
6923 @end smallexample
6924 @noindent
6925 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6926 address}.
6927
6928 @node Expression Section
6929 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6930 @cindex expression sections
6931 @cindex absolute expressions
6932 @cindex relative expressions
6933 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6934 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6935 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6936 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6937 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6938 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6939 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6940 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6941 operations.
6942
6943 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6944 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6945 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6946 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6947 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6948 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6949 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6950 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6951 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6952 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6953 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6954 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6955 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6956 everywhere.
6957
6958 In the following simple example,
6959
6960 @smallexample
6961 @group
6962 SECTIONS
6963 @{
6964 . = 0x100;
6965 __executable_start = 0x100;
6966 .data :
6967 @{
6968 . = 0x10;
6969 __data_start = 0x10;
6970 *(.data)
6971 @}
6972 @dots{}
6973 @}
6974 @end group
6975 @end smallexample
6976
6977 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6978 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6979 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6980 section in the second two assignments.
6981
6982 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6983 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6984
6985 @itemize @bullet
6986 @item
6987 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6988 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6989 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6990 @item
6991 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6992 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6993 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6994 @item
6995 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6996 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6997 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6998 before applying the operator.
6999 @end itemize
7000
7001 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7002
7003 @itemize @bullet
7004 @item
7005 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7006 @item
7007 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7008 @item
7009 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
7010 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
7011 (after above conversions) is also a number when
7012 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7013 but an absolute address otherwise.
7014 @item
7015 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7016 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7017 section as the relative operand(s).
7018 @item
7019 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7020 conversions) is an absolute address.
7021 @end itemize
7022
7023 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7024 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7025 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7026 section @samp{.data}:
7027 @smallexample
7028 SECTIONS
7029 @{
7030 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7031 @}
7032 @end smallexample
7033 @noindent
7034 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7035 @samp{.data} section.
7036
7037 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7038 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7039
7040 @node Builtin Functions
7041 @subsection Builtin Functions
7042 @cindex functions in expressions
7043 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7044 use in linker script expressions.
7045
7046 @table @code
7047 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7048 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7049 @cindex expression, absolute
7050 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7051 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7052 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7053 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7054
7055 @item ADDR(@var{section})
7056 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7057 @cindex section address in expression
7058 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
7059 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7060 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7061 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7062 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7063 the other two will be absolute:
7064 @smallexample
7065 @group
7066 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7067 .output1 :
7068 @{
7069 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7070 @dots{}
7071 @}
7072 .output :
7073 @{
7074 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7075 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7076 @}
7077 @dots{} @}
7078 @end group
7079 @end smallexample
7080
7081 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
7082 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7083 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7084 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7085 @cindex round up location counter
7086 @cindex align location counter
7087 @cindex round up expression
7088 @cindex align expression
7089 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7090 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7091 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7092 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7093 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
7094 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
7095
7096 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7097 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7098 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7099 input sections:
7100 @smallexample
7101 @group
7102 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7103 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7104 *(.data)
7105 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7106 @}
7107 @dots{} @}
7108 @end group
7109 @end smallexample
7110 @noindent
7111 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7112 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7113 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7114 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7115
7116 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7117
7118 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7119 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7120 @cindex section alignment
7121 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7122 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7123 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7124 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7125 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7126 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7127 example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7128 first value in that section.
7129 @smallexample
7130 @group
7131 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7132 .output @{
7133 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7134 @dots{}
7135 @}
7136 @dots{} @}
7137 @end group
7138 @end smallexample
7139
7140 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7141 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7142 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7143 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7144 section.
7145
7146 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7147 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7148 This is equivalent to either
7149 @smallexample
7150 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7151 @end smallexample
7152 or
7153 @smallexample
7154 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7155 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
7156 @end smallexample
7157 @noindent
7158 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7159 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7160 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7161 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7162 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7163 bytes in the on-disk file.
7164
7165 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7166 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7167 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
7168 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7169 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7170 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7171 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
7172
7173 @noindent
7174 Example:
7175 @smallexample
7176 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7177 @end smallexample
7178
7179 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7180 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7181 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7182 evaluation purposes.
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7186 @end smallexample
7187
7188 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7189 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7190 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7191 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7192 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7193 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7194 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7195 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7196 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7197 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7198 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7199 section alignment.
7200
7201 @smallexample
7202 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7203 @end smallexample
7204
7205 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7206 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7207 @cindex symbol defaults
7208 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7209 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7210 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7211 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7212 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7213 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7214 existed, its value is preserved:
7215
7216 @smallexample
7217 @group
7218 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7219 .text : @{
7220 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7221 @dots{}
7222 @}
7223 @dots{}
7224 @}
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7229 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7230 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7231
7232 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7233 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7234 @cindex section load address in expression
7235 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7236 Section LMA}).
7237
7238 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7239 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7240 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7241 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7242
7243 @kindex MAX
7244 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7245 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7246
7247 @kindex MIN
7248 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7249 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7250
7251 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7252 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7253 @cindex unallocated address, next
7254 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7255 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7256 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7257 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7258
7259 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7260 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7261 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7262
7263 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7264 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7265 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7266 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7267 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7268 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7269 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7270 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7271 name.
7272
7273 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7274 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7275 @cindex section size
7276 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7277 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7278 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7279 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7280 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7281 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7282 example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7283 values:
7284 @smallexample
7285 @group
7286 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7287 .output @{
7288 .start = . ;
7289 @dots{}
7290 .end = . ;
7291 @}
7292 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7293 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7294 @dots{} @}
7295 @end group
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7299 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7300 @cindex header size
7301 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7302 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7303 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7304 choose, to facilitate paging.
7305
7306 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7307 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7308 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7309 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7310 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7311 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7312 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7313 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7314 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7315 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7316 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7317 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7318 @end table
7319
7320 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7321 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7322 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7323 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7324 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7325 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7326 linker will report an error.
7327
7328 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7329
7330 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7331 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7332 commands.
7333
7334 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7335 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7336 read. This can affect archive searching.
7337
7338 @node Plugins
7339 @chapter Linker Plugins
7340
7341 @cindex plugins
7342 @cindex linker plugins
7343 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7344 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7345 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7346
7347 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7348 be added here later.
7349
7350 Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
7351 command line option. @xref{Options}.
7352
7353 @menu
7354 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7355 @end menu
7356
7357 @node libdep Plugin
7358 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7359 @cindex static library dependencies
7360 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7361 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7362 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7363 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7364 rose to ascendance.
7365
7366 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7367 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7368 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7369 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7370 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7371 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7372 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7373 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7374
7375 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7376 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7377 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7378 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7379 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7380 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7381 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7382 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7383 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7384
7385 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7386 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7387 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7388
7389 @smallexample
7390 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7391 @end smallexample
7392
7393 @ifset GENERIC
7394 @node Machine Dependent
7395 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7396
7397 @cindex machine dependencies
7398 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7399 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7400 functionality are not listed.
7401
7402 @menu
7403 @ifset H8300
7404 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7405 @end ifset
7406 @ifset M68HC11
7407 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7408 @end ifset
7409 @ifset ARM
7410 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7411 @end ifset
7412 @ifset HPPA
7413 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7414 @end ifset
7415 @ifset M68K
7416 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7417 @end ifset
7418 @ifset MIPS
7419 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7420 @end ifset
7421 @ifset MMIX
7422 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7423 @end ifset
7424 @ifset MSP430
7425 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7426 @end ifset
7427 @ifset NDS32
7428 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7429 @end ifset
7430 @ifset NIOSII
7431 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7432 @end ifset
7433 @ifset POWERPC
7434 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7435 @end ifset
7436 @ifset POWERPC64
7437 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7438 @end ifset
7439 @ifset S/390
7440 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7441 @end ifset
7442 @ifset SPU
7443 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7444 @end ifset
7445 @ifset TICOFF
7446 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7447 @end ifset
7448 @ifset WIN32
7449 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7450 @end ifset
7451 @ifset XTENSA
7452 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7453 @end ifset
7454 @end menu
7455 @end ifset
7456
7457 @ifset H8300
7458 @ifclear GENERIC
7459 @raisesections
7460 @end ifclear
7461
7462 @node H8/300
7463 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7464
7465 @cindex H8/300 support
7466 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7467 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7468
7469 @table @emph
7470 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7471 @item relaxing address modes
7472 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7473 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7474 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7475 respectively.
7476
7477 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7478 @item synthesizing instructions
7479 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7480 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7481 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7482 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7483 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7484 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7485 top page of memory).
7486
7487 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7488 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7489 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7490 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7491 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7492 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7493 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7494
7495 @item bit manipulation instructions
7496 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7497 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7498 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7499 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7500 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7501 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7502 the top page of memory).
7503
7504 @item system control instructions
7505 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7506 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7507 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7508 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7509 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7510 the top page of memory).
7511 @end table
7512
7513 @ifclear GENERIC
7514 @lowersections
7515 @end ifclear
7516 @end ifset
7517
7518 @ifclear GENERIC
7519 @ifset Renesas
7520 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7521 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7522 @node Renesas
7523 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7524
7525 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7526 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7527 options are required for these chips.
7528 @end ifset
7529 @end ifclear
7530
7531 @ifset ARM
7532 @ifclear GENERIC
7533 @raisesections
7534 @end ifclear
7535
7536 @ifset M68HC11
7537 @ifclear GENERIC
7538 @raisesections
7539 @end ifclear
7540
7541 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7542 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7543
7544 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7545
7546 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7547
7548 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7549 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7550
7551 @table @emph
7552 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7553 @item relaxing address modes
7554 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7555 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7556 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7557 respectively.
7558
7559 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7560 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7561 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7562
7563 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7564 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7565 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7566 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7567 @code{bset} instructions.
7568
7569 @end table
7570
7571 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7572
7573 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7574 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7575 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7576 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7577 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7578 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7579 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7580 point to the function trampoline.
7581
7582 @ifclear GENERIC
7583 @lowersections
7584 @end ifclear
7585 @end ifset
7586
7587 @node ARM
7588 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7589
7590 @cindex ARM interworking support
7591 @kindex --support-old-code
7592 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7593 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7594 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7595 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7596 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7597 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7598 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7599 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7600 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7601 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7602
7603 @cindex thumb entry point
7604 @cindex entry point, thumb
7605 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7606 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7607 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7608 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7609 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7610 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7611
7612 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7613 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7614 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7615 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7616 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7617 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7618
7619 @cindex BE8
7620 @kindex --be8
7621 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7622 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7623 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7624 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7625 little-endian code.
7626
7627 @cindex TARGET1
7628 @kindex --target1-rel
7629 @kindex --target1-abs
7630 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7631 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7632 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7633 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7634
7635 @cindex TARGET2
7636 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7637 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7638 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7639 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7640 @table @samp
7641 @item rel
7642 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7643 @item abs
7644 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7645 @item got-rel
7646 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7647 @end table
7648
7649 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7650 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7651 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7652 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7653 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7654 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7655
7656 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7657 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7658 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7659
7660 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7661 relocations are ignored.
7662
7663 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7664 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7665 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7666 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 TST rM, #1
7670 MOVEQ PC, rM
7671 BX Rn
7672 @end smallexample
7673
7674 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7675 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7676 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7677
7678 @cindex USE_BLX
7679 @kindex --use-blx
7680 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7681 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7682 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7683 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7684 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7685
7686 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7687 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7688 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7689 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7690 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7691 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7692 the support code can read the intended values.
7693
7694 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7695 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7696 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7697 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7698 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7699 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7700
7701 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7702 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7703 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7704 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7705 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7706 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7707
7708 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7709 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7710 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7711 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7712 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7713 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7714 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7715
7716 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7717 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7718 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7719 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7720 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7721 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7722 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7723
7724 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7725 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7726 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7727
7728 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7729 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7730
7731 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7732 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7733 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7734 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7735 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7736 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7737 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7738 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7739
7740 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7741 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7742
7743 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7744 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7745 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7746 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7747 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7748
7749 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7750 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7751 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7752 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7753 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7754 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7755
7756 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7757 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7758
7759 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7760 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7761 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7762 occurs.
7763
7764 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7765 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7766 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7767 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7768 occurs.
7769
7770 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7771 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7772 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7773 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7774 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7775 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7776 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7777 not be diagnosed.
7778
7779 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7780 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7781 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7782 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7783 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7784 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7785 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7786
7787 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7788 @kindex --pic-veneer
7789 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7790 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7791 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7792 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7793
7794 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7795 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7796 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7797 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7798 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7799 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7800 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7801 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7802 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7803 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7804 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7805 where they should be placed.
7806
7807 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7808 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7809 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7810 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7811 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7812 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7813 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7814 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7815 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7816 from the input sections.
7817
7818 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7819 @samp{N = +1}.
7820
7821 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7822 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7823 otherwise.
7824
7825 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7826 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7827 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7828 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7829
7830 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7831
7832 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7833 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7834 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7835 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7836
7837 Please contact ARM for further details.
7838
7839 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7840 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7841 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7842 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7843
7844 @kindex --long-plt
7845 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7846 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7847 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7848 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7849
7850 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7851 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7852 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7853 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7854
7855 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7856 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7857 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7858 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7859 veneers in memory.
7860
7861 @kindex --cmse-implib
7862 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7863 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7864 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7865 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7866 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7867
7868 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7869 @cindex Input import library
7870 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7871 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7872 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7873 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7874 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7875 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7876 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7877 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7878 specified.
7879
7880 @ifclear GENERIC
7881 @lowersections
7882 @end ifclear
7883 @end ifset
7884
7885 @ifset HPPA
7886 @ifclear GENERIC
7887 @raisesections
7888 @end ifclear
7889
7890 @node HPPA ELF32
7891 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7892 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7893 @kindex --multi-subspace
7894 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7895 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7896 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7897 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7898 multiple sub-spaces.
7899
7900 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7901 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7902 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7903 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7904 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7905 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7906 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7907 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7908 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7909 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7910 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7911 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7912 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7913 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7914 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7915 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7916
7917 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7918 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7919 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7920 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7921
7922 @ifclear GENERIC
7923 @lowersections
7924 @end ifclear
7925 @end ifset
7926
7927 @ifset M68K
7928 @ifclear GENERIC
7929 @raisesections
7930 @end ifclear
7931
7932 @node M68K
7933 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7934
7935 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7936 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7937 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7938 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7939 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7940 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7941 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7942 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7943 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7944 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7945 support such GOTs.
7946 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7947 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7948 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7949 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7950
7951 @ifclear GENERIC
7952 @lowersections
7953 @end ifclear
7954 @end ifset
7955
7956 @ifset MIPS
7957 @ifclear GENERIC
7958 @raisesections
7959 @end ifclear
7960
7961 @node MIPS
7962 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7963
7964 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7965 @kindex --insn32
7966 @kindex --no-insn32
7967 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7968 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7969 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7970 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7971 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7972 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7973
7974 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7975 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7976 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7977 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7978 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7979 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7980 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7981 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7982 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7983 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7984 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7985 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7986
7987 @ifclear GENERIC
7988 @lowersections
7989 @end ifclear
7990 @end ifset
7991
7992 @ifset MMIX
7993 @ifclear GENERIC
7994 @raisesections
7995 @end ifclear
7996
7997 @node MMIX
7998 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7999 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8000 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8001 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8002 can translate between the two formats.
8003
8004 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8005 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8006 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8007 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8008 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8009 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8010 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8011 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8012
8013 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8014 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8015 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8016 of a section.
8017
8018 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8019 are left out from an mmo file.
8020
8021 @ifclear GENERIC
8022 @lowersections
8023 @end ifclear
8024 @end ifset
8025
8026 @ifset MSP430
8027 @ifclear GENERIC
8028 @raisesections
8029 @end ifclear
8030
8031 @node MSP430
8032 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
8033 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8034 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8035 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8036
8037 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
8038 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8039
8040 @table @code
8041 @item @samp{.vectors}
8042 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8043
8044 @item @samp{.bootloader}
8045 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8046 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8047
8048 @item @samp{.infomem}
8049 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8050 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8051
8052 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
8053 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8054 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8055
8056 @item @samp{.noinit}
8057 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8058
8059 The last two sections are used by gcc.
8060 @end table
8061
8062 @table @option
8063 @cindex MSP430 Options
8064 @kindex --code-region
8065 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8066 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8067 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8068 using this option.
8069
8070 @kindex --data-region
8071 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8072 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8073 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8074 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8075
8076 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8077 @item --disable-sec-transformation
8078 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8079 and @code{--data-region} options.
8080 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8081 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8082 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8083 @end table
8084
8085 @ifclear GENERIC
8086 @lowersections
8087 @end ifclear
8088 @end ifset
8089
8090 @ifset NDS32
8091 @ifclear GENERIC
8092 @raisesections
8093 @end ifclear
8094
8095 @node NDS32
8096 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
8097 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
8098 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8099 relaxes objects according to these options.
8100
8101 @table @code
8102 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8103 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8104
8105 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8106 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8107
8108 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8109 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8110
8111 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8112 Export the EX9 table after linking.
8113
8114 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8115 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8116
8117 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8118 Update the existing EX9 table.
8119
8120 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8121 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8122
8123 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8124 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8125
8126 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8127 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8128
8129 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8130 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8131 @end table
8132
8133 @ifclear GENERIC
8134 @lowersections
8135 @end ifclear
8136 @end ifset
8137
8138 @ifset NIOSII
8139 @ifclear GENERIC
8140 @raisesections
8141 @end ifclear
8142
8143 @node Nios II
8144 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8145 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
8146 @kindex --relax on Nios II
8147
8148 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8149 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8150 which may result in @command{ld} giving
8151 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8152 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8153 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8154 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8155 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8156 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8157 larger than 256MB.
8158
8159 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8160 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8161 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8162 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8163 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8164 register as a temporary.
8165
8166 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8167 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8168 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8169
8170 @ifclear GENERIC
8171 @lowersections
8172 @end ifclear
8173 @end ifset
8174
8175 @ifset POWERPC
8176 @ifclear GENERIC
8177 @raisesections
8178 @end ifclear
8179
8180 @node PowerPC ELF32
8181 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8182 @cindex PowerPC long branches
8183 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8184 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8185 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8186 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8187 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8188 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8189 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8190 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8191 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8192 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8193 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8194
8195 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8196 @table @option
8197 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8198 @kindex --bss-plt
8199 @item --bss-plt
8200 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8201 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8202 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8203 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8204 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8205 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8206 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8207 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8208
8209 @kindex --secure-plt
8210 @item --secure-plt
8211 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8212 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8213 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8214 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8215 style BSS PLT.
8216
8217 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8218 @kindex --sdata-got
8219 @item --sdata-got
8220 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8221 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8222 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8223 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8224 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8225 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8226 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8227 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8228 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8229 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8230 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8231 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8232
8233 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8234 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8235 @item --emit-stub-syms
8236 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8237 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8238
8239 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8240 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8241 @item --no-tls-optimize
8242 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8243 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8244 disable the optimization.
8245 @end table
8246
8247 @ifclear GENERIC
8248 @lowersections
8249 @end ifclear
8250 @end ifset
8251
8252 @ifset POWERPC64
8253 @ifclear GENERIC
8254 @raisesections
8255 @end ifclear
8256
8257 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8258 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8259
8260 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8261 @table @option
8262 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8263 @kindex --stub-group-size
8264 @item --stub-group-size
8265 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8266 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8267 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8268 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8269 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8270 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8271 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8272 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8273 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8274 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8275 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8276 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8277 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8278 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8279
8280 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8281 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8282 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8283 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8284
8285 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8286 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8287 @item --emit-stub-syms
8288 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8289 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8290
8291 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8292 @kindex --dotsyms
8293 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8294 @item --dotsyms
8295 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8296 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8297 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8298 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8299 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8300 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8301 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8302 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8303 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8304 feature.
8305
8306 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8307 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8308 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8309 @item --save-restore-funcs
8310 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8311 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8312 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8313 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8314 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8315 link.
8316
8317 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8318 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8319 @item --no-tls-optimize
8320 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8321 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8322 disable the optimization.
8323
8324 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8325 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8326 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8327 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8328 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8329 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8330 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8331 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8332 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8333 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8334 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8335 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8336 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8337 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8338 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8339 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8340 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8341 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8342 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8343 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8344 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8345 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8346 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8347 register saves.
8348
8349 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8350 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8351 @item --no-opd-optimize
8352 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8353 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8354 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8355 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8356
8357 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8358 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8359 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8360 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8361 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8362 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8363 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8364
8365 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8366 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8367 @item --no-toc-optimize
8368 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8369 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8370 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8371 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8372 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8373 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8374 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8375 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8376 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8377 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8378 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8379 optimization.
8380
8381 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8382 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8383 @item --no-inline-optimize
8384 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8385 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8386 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8387 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8388 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8389 disables that optimization.
8390
8391 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8392 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8393 @item --no-multi-toc
8394 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8395 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8396 where TOC
8397 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8398 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8399 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8400 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8401 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8402 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8403 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8404 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8405
8406 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8407 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8408 @item --no-toc-sort
8409 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8410 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8411 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8412 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8413 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8414 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8415 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8416 off this feature.
8417
8418 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8419 @kindex --plt-align
8420 @kindex --no-plt-align
8421 @item --plt-align
8422 @itemx --no-plt-align
8423 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8424 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8425 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8426 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8427 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8428 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8429 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8430
8431 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8432 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8433 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8434 @item --plt-static-chain
8435 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8436 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8437 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8438 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8439
8440 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8441 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8442 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8443 @item --plt-thread-safe
8444 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8445 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8446 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8447 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8448 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8449 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8450 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8451 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8452 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8453 default behaviour.
8454
8455 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8456 @kindex --plt-localentry
8457 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8458 @item --plt-localentry
8459 @itemx --no-localentry
8460 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8461 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8462 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8463 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8464 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8465 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8466 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8467 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8468 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8469 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8470 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8471 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8472
8473 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8474 @kindex --power10-stubs
8475 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8476 @item --power10-stubs
8477 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8478 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8479 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8480 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8481 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8482 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8483 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8484 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8485 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8486 auto mode.
8487 @end table
8488
8489 @ifclear GENERIC
8490 @lowersections
8491 @end ifclear
8492 @end ifset
8493
8494 @ifset S/390
8495 @ifclear GENERIC
8496 @raisesections
8497 @end ifclear
8498
8499 @node S/390 ELF
8500 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8501
8502 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8503 @table @option
8504
8505 @cindex S/390
8506 @kindex --s390-pgste
8507 @item --s390-pgste
8508 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8509 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8510 binaries marked that way.
8511 @end table
8512
8513 @ifclear GENERIC
8514 @lowersections
8515 @end ifclear
8516 @end ifset
8517
8518 @ifset SPU
8519 @ifclear GENERIC
8520 @raisesections
8521 @end ifclear
8522
8523 @node SPU ELF
8524 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8525
8526 @cindex SPU ELF options
8527 @table @option
8528
8529 @cindex SPU plugins
8530 @kindex --plugin
8531 @item --plugin
8532 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8533
8534 @cindex SPU overlays
8535 @kindex --no-overlays
8536 @item --no-overlays
8537 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8538 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8539 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8540 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8541
8542 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8543 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8544 @item --emit-stub-syms
8545 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8546 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8547
8548 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8549 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8550 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8551 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8552 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8553 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8554
8555 @cindex SPU local store size
8556 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8557 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8558 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8559 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8560 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8561
8562 @cindex SPU
8563 @kindex --stack-analysis
8564 @item --stack-analysis
8565 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8566 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8567 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8568 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8569 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8570 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8571 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8572 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8573 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8574 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8575 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8576 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8577 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8578 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8579 and calls will be given.
8580
8581 @cindex SPU
8582 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8583 @item --emit-stack-syms
8584 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8585 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8586 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8587 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8588 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8589 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8590 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8591 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8592 @end table
8593
8594 @ifclear GENERIC
8595 @lowersections
8596 @end ifclear
8597 @end ifset
8598
8599 @ifset TICOFF
8600 @ifclear GENERIC
8601 @raisesections
8602 @end ifclear
8603
8604 @node TI COFF
8605 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8606 @cindex TI COFF versions
8607 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8608 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8609 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8610 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8611 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8612 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8613
8614 @ifclear GENERIC
8615 @lowersections
8616 @end ifclear
8617 @end ifset
8618
8619 @ifset WIN32
8620 @ifclear GENERIC
8621 @raisesections
8622 @end ifclear
8623
8624 @node WIN32
8625 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8626
8627 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8628 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8629 command-line options mentioned here.
8630
8631 @table @emph
8632 @cindex import libraries
8633 @item import libraries
8634 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8635 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8636 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8637 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8638 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8639 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8640
8641 @item Resource only DLLs
8642 It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8643 @samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8644 must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
8645 will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
8646 there is no input to go into them.
8647
8648 The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8649 should be changed to match the desired format.
8650
8651 @example
8652 OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8653 SECTIONS
8654 @{
8655 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8656 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8657 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8658 @{
8659 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8660 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8661 @}
8662 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8663 @}
8664 @end example
8665
8666 With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8667 line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8668 @file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8669
8670 @smallexample
8671 ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8672 @end smallexample
8673
8674 @item exporting DLL symbols
8675 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8676 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8677
8678 @table @emph
8679 @item using auto-export functionality
8680 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8681 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8682 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8683
8684 @itemize
8685 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8686 @item --exclude-symbols
8687 @item --exclude-libs
8688 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8689 @item --version-script
8690 @end itemize
8691
8692 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8693 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8694 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8695 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8696 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8697 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8698 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8699 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8700
8701 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8702 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8703 if either of the following are true:
8704
8705 @itemize
8706 @item A DEF file is used.
8707 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8708 @end itemize
8709
8710 @item using a DEF file
8711 @cindex using a DEF file
8712 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8713 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8714 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8715 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8716 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8717
8718 @example
8719 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8720 @end example
8721
8722 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8723 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8724
8725 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8726
8727 @example
8728 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8729
8730 EXPORTS
8731 foo
8732 bar
8733 _bar = bar
8734 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8735 var1 DATA
8736 doo = foo == foo2
8737 eoo DATA == var1
8738 @end example
8739
8740 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8741 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8742 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8743 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8744 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8745 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8746 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8747 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8748 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8749
8750 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8751 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8752 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8753
8754 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8755 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8756 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8757 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8758
8759 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8760 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8761 non-default base address for the image.
8762
8763 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8764 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8765 filename specified on the command line.
8766
8767 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8768
8769 @example
8770 EXPORTS
8771 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8772 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8773 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8774 @end example
8775
8776 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8777 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8778 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8779 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8780 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8781 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8782 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8783
8784 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8785
8786 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8787 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8788 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8789 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8790 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8791
8792 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8793 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8794 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8795 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8796
8797 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8798 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8799 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8800 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8801 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8802 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8803 application will behave unexpectedly.
8804
8805 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8806 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8807 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8808 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8809 the DLL without an import library.
8810
8811 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8812 other DEF file statements
8813
8814 @cindex creating a DEF file
8815 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8816 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8817
8818 @item Using decorations
8819 @cindex Using decorations
8820 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8821 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8822 declared as:
8823
8824 @example
8825 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8826 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8827 @end example
8828
8829 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8830 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8831 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8832 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8833
8834 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8835 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8836 instead:
8837
8838 @example
8839 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8840 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8841 @end example
8842
8843 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8844 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8845 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8846 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8847 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8848 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8849 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8850 information.
8851 @end table
8852
8853 @cindex automatic data imports
8854 @item automatic data imports
8855 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8856 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8857 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8858 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8859 code to these platforms, especially for large
8860 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8861 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8862 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8863 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8864 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8865 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8866 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8867 trigger the feature's use.
8868
8869 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8870 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8871
8872 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8873 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8874
8875 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8876 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8877 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8878 below.
8879
8880 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8881 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8882 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8883 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8884 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8885 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8886 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8887 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8888 references.
8889
8890 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8891 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8892 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8893 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8894 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8895 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8896 run without error on an older system.
8897
8898 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8899 enabled as needed.
8900
8901 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8902 @item direct linking to a dll
8903 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8904 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8905 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8906 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8907 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8908 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8909 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8910 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8911 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8912 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8913
8914 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8915 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8916 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8917 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8918 select the dll instead of an import library.
8919
8920
8921 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8922 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8923
8924 @example
8925 libxxx.dll.a
8926 xxx.dll.a
8927 libxxx.a
8928 xxx.lib
8929 libxxx.lib
8930 cygxxx.dll (*)
8931 libxxx.dll
8932 xxx.dll
8933 @end example
8934
8935 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8936
8937 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8938 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8939 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8940 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8941 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8942
8943 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8944 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8945 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8946 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8947 could coexist on the same machine.
8948
8949 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8950 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8951 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8952
8953 @example
8954 bin/
8955 cygxxx.dll
8956 lib/
8957 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8958 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8959 @end example
8960
8961 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8962 done two ways:
8963
8964 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8965 @example
8966 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8967 @end example
8968
8969 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8970 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8971 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8972 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8973
8974 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8975 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8976 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8977 making the app/dll.
8978
8979 @example
8980 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8981 @end example
8982
8983 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8984
8985 @example
8986 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8987 @end example
8988
8989 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8990 perfectly legal
8991
8992 @example
8993 bin/
8994 cygxxx-5.dll
8995 lib/
8996 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8997 @end example
8998
8999 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
9000 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9001 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9002
9003 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
9004 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
9005
9006 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9007 work with auto-imported data.
9008
9009 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9010 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9011 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9012 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9013 possible to do this without an import lib.
9014
9015 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9016 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9017 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9018 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9019
9020 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
9021 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9022 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9023 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
9024 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9025 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9026 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
9027
9028 @item symbol aliasing
9029 @table @emph
9030 @item adding additional names
9031 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
9032 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9033 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9034 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
9035 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
9036
9037 @example
9038 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9039
9040 EXPORTS
9041 foo
9042 _foo = foo
9043 @end example
9044
9045 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9046
9047 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9048 source code using the "weak" attribute:
9049
9050 @example
9051 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
9052 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
9053 @end example
9054
9055 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9056 symbols.
9057
9058 @item renaming symbols
9059 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
9060 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
9061 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9062 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
9063 created). In the following example:
9064
9065 @example
9066 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9067
9068 EXPORTS
9069 _foo = foo
9070 @end example
9071
9072 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9073 @samp{_foo}.
9074 @end table
9075
9076 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
9077 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
9078 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
9079 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9080 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9081 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9082 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9083 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9084 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9085 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
9086 which is probably not what you wanted.
9087
9088 @cindex weak externals
9089 @item weak externals
9090 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9091 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9092 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9093 are three variants of weak externals:
9094 @itemize
9095 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9096 called lazy externals.
9097 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9098 This form is not presently implemented.
9099 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9100 implemented.
9101 @end itemize
9102 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9103 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9104 uses a default value.
9105
9106 @cindex aligned common symbols
9107 @item aligned common symbols
9108 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9109 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9110 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9111 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9112 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9113 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9114 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9115 warnings about unknown linker directives.
9116
9117 @end table
9118
9119 @ifclear GENERIC
9120 @lowersections
9121 @end ifclear
9122 @end ifset
9123
9124 @ifset XTENSA
9125 @ifclear GENERIC
9126 @raisesections
9127 @end ifclear
9128
9129 @node Xtensa
9130 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9131
9132 @cindex Xtensa processors
9133 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9134 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9135 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9136 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9137 example, with the command:
9138
9139 @smallexample
9140 SECTIONS
9141 @{
9142 .text : @{
9143 *(.literal .text)
9144 @}
9145 @}
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9150 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9151 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9152 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9153 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9154 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9155 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
9156
9157 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
9158 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
9159 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9160 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9161 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9162 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9163 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9164 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9165 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9166 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9167 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9168 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9169
9170 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9171 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9172 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9173 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9174 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9175 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9176 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9177 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9178 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9179 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9180 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9181 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9182 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9183 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9184
9185 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9186 control the linker:
9187
9188 @cindex Xtensa options
9189 @table @option
9190 @item --size-opt
9191 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9192 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9193 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9194 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9195 preserve the correctness of the code.
9196
9197 @item --abi-windowed
9198 @itemx --abi-call0
9199 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9200 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9201 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9202 conventions.
9203 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9204 of the first input object.
9205 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9206 or the chosen output object ABI.
9207 @end table
9208
9209 @ifclear GENERIC
9210 @lowersections
9211 @end ifclear
9212 @end ifset
9213
9214 @ifclear SingleFormat
9215 @node BFD
9216 @chapter BFD
9217
9218 @cindex back end
9219 @cindex object file management
9220 @cindex object formats available
9221 @kindex objdump -i
9222 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9223 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9224 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9225 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9226 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9227 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9228 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9229 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9230 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9231
9232 @cindex BFD requirements
9233 @cindex requirements for BFD
9234 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9235 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9236 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9237 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9238 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9239 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9240 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9241
9242 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9243 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9244 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9245 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9246
9247 @menu
9248 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9249 @end menu
9250
9251 @node BFD outline
9252 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9253 @cindex opening object files
9254 @include bfdsumm.texi
9255 @end ifclear
9256
9257 @node Reporting Bugs
9258 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9259 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9260 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9261
9262 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9263
9264 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9265 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9266 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9267 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9268 @command{ld}.
9269
9270 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9271 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9272
9273 @menu
9274 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9275 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9276 @end menu
9277
9278 @node Bug Criteria
9279 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9280 @cindex bug criteria
9281
9282 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9283
9284 @itemize @bullet
9285 @cindex fatal signal
9286 @cindex linker crash
9287 @cindex crash of linker
9288 @item
9289 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9290 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9291
9292 @cindex error on valid input
9293 @item
9294 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9295
9296 @cindex invalid input
9297 @item
9298 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9299 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9300 object files are correct.
9301
9302 @item
9303 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9304 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9305 @end itemize
9306
9307 @node Bug Reporting
9308 @section How to Report Bugs
9309 @cindex bug reports
9310 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9311
9312 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9313 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9314 recommend you contact that organization first.
9315
9316 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9317 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9318 distribution.
9319
9320 @ifset BUGURL
9321 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9322 @value{BUGURL}.
9323 @end ifset
9324
9325 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9326 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9327 fact or leave it out, state it!
9328
9329 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9330 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9331 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9332 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9333 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9334 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9335 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9336 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9337 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9338 and the most helpful.
9339
9340 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9341 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9342 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9343
9344 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9345 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9346 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9347 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9348
9349 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9350
9351 @itemize @bullet
9352 @item
9353 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9354 the @samp{--version} argument.
9355
9356 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9357 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9358
9359 @item
9360 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9361 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9362
9363 @item
9364 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9365 version number.
9366
9367 @item
9368 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9369 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9370
9371 @item
9372 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9373 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9374 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9375 sufficient.
9376
9377 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9378 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9379
9380 @item
9381 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9382 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9383 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9384 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9385 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9386 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9387 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9388 attachments are best.
9389
9390 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9391 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9392 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9393 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9394 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9395
9396 @item
9397 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9398 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9399
9400 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9401 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9402 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9403 a chance to make a mistake.
9404
9405 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9406 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9407 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9408 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9409 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9410 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9411 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9412 any conclusion from our observations.
9413
9414 @item
9415 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9416 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9417 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9418 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9419 context, not by line number.
9420
9421 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9422 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9423 @end itemize
9424
9425 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9426
9427 @itemize @bullet
9428 @item
9429 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9430
9431 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9432 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9433 changes will not affect it.
9434
9435 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9436 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9437 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9438 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9439
9440 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9441 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9442 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9443 less time, and so on.
9444
9445 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9446 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9447
9448 @item
9449 A patch for the bug.
9450
9451 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9452 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9453 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9454 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9455
9456 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9457 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9458 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9459 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9460 fixed.
9461
9462 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9463 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9464 help us to understand.
9465
9466 @item
9467 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9468
9469 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9470 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9471 @end itemize
9472
9473 @node MRI
9474 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9475 @cindex MRI compatibility
9476 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9477 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9478 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9479 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9480 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9481 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9482 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9483
9484 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9485 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9486 features to make use of them.
9487
9488 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9489 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9490
9491 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9492 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9493 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9494 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9495 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9496
9497 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9498
9499 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9500 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9501 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9502
9503 @table @code
9504 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9505 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9506 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9507 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9508 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9509 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9510 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9511 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9512 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9513 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9514 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9515
9516 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9517 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9518 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9519 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9520
9521 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9522
9523 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9524 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9525 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9526 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9527
9528 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9529 @item BASE @var{expression}
9530 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9531 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9532
9533 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9534 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9535 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9536 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9537
9538 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9539 @item END
9540 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9541
9542 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9543 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9544 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9545 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9546
9547 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9548 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9549 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9550 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9551
9552 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9553 same line, with no change in its effect.
9554
9555 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9556 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9557 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9558 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9559 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9560 command line.
9561
9562 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9563 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9564 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9565 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9566 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9567
9568 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9569 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9570 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9571 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9572 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9573 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9574 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9575 file, in the order specified.
9576
9577 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9578 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9579 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9580 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9581 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9582 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9583
9584 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9585 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9586 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9587 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9588 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9589 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9590 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9591 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9592 @end table
9593
9594 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9595 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9596 @include fdl.texi
9597
9598 @node LD Index
9599 @unnumbered LD Index
9600
9601 @printindex cp
9602
9603 @tex
9604 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9605 % meantime:
9606 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9607 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9608 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9609 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9610 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9611 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9612 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9613 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9614 \page\colophon
9615 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9616 @end tex
9617
9618 @bye